21420 lines
668 KiB
Go
21420 lines
668 KiB
Go
// Code generated by private/model/cli/gen-api/main.go. DO NOT EDIT.
|
|
|
|
package glue
|
|
|
|
import (
|
|
"fmt"
|
|
"time"
|
|
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awsutil"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/request"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const opBatchCreatePartition = "BatchCreatePartition"
|
|
|
|
// BatchCreatePartitionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the BatchCreatePartition operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchCreatePartition for more information on using the BatchCreatePartition
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the BatchCreatePartitionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.BatchCreatePartitionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchCreatePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchCreatePartitionRequest(input *BatchCreatePartitionInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchCreatePartitionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opBatchCreatePartition,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &BatchCreatePartitionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &BatchCreatePartitionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchCreatePartition API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates one or more partitions in a batch operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation BatchCreatePartition for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchCreatePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchCreatePartition(input *BatchCreatePartitionInput) (*BatchCreatePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchCreatePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchCreatePartitionWithContext is the same as BatchCreatePartition with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchCreatePartition for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchCreatePartitionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchCreatePartitionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchCreatePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchCreatePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opBatchDeleteConnection = "BatchDeleteConnection"
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteConnectionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the BatchDeleteConnection operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchDeleteConnection for more information on using the BatchDeleteConnection
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the BatchDeleteConnectionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.BatchDeleteConnectionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchDeleteConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteConnectionRequest(input *BatchDeleteConnectionInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchDeleteConnectionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opBatchDeleteConnection,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &BatchDeleteConnectionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &BatchDeleteConnectionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteConnection API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a list of connection definitions from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation BatchDeleteConnection for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchDeleteConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteConnection(input *BatchDeleteConnectionInput) (*BatchDeleteConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchDeleteConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteConnectionWithContext is the same as BatchDeleteConnection with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchDeleteConnection for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteConnectionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchDeleteConnectionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchDeleteConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchDeleteConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opBatchDeletePartition = "BatchDeletePartition"
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeletePartitionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the BatchDeletePartition operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchDeletePartition for more information on using the BatchDeletePartition
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the BatchDeletePartitionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.BatchDeletePartitionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchDeletePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeletePartitionRequest(input *BatchDeletePartitionInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchDeletePartitionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opBatchDeletePartition,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &BatchDeletePartitionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &BatchDeletePartitionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeletePartition API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes one or more partitions in a batch operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation BatchDeletePartition for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchDeletePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeletePartition(input *BatchDeletePartitionInput) (*BatchDeletePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchDeletePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeletePartitionWithContext is the same as BatchDeletePartition with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchDeletePartition for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeletePartitionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchDeletePartitionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchDeletePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchDeletePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opBatchDeleteTable = "BatchDeleteTable"
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteTableRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the BatchDeleteTable operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchDeleteTable for more information on using the BatchDeleteTable
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the BatchDeleteTableRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.BatchDeleteTableRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchDeleteTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteTableRequest(input *BatchDeleteTableInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchDeleteTableOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opBatchDeleteTable,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &BatchDeleteTableInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &BatchDeleteTableOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteTable API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes multiple tables at once.
|
|
//
|
|
// After completing this operation, you will no longer have access to the table
|
|
// versions and partitions that belong to the deleted table. AWS Glue deletes
|
|
// these "orphaned" resources asynchronously in a timely manner, at the discretion
|
|
// of the service.
|
|
//
|
|
// To ensure immediate deletion of all related resources, before calling BatchDeleteTable,
|
|
// use DeleteTableVersion or BatchDeleteTableVersion, and DeletePartition or
|
|
// BatchDeletePartition, to delete any resources that belong to the table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation BatchDeleteTable for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchDeleteTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteTable(input *BatchDeleteTableInput) (*BatchDeleteTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchDeleteTableRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteTableWithContext is the same as BatchDeleteTable with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchDeleteTable for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteTableWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchDeleteTableInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchDeleteTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchDeleteTableRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opBatchDeleteTableVersion = "BatchDeleteTableVersion"
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteTableVersionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the BatchDeleteTableVersion operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchDeleteTableVersion for more information on using the BatchDeleteTableVersion
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the BatchDeleteTableVersionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.BatchDeleteTableVersionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchDeleteTableVersion
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteTableVersionRequest(input *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opBatchDeleteTableVersion,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &BatchDeleteTableVersionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteTableVersion API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a specified batch of versions of a table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation BatchDeleteTableVersion for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchDeleteTableVersion
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteTableVersion(input *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) (*BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchDeleteTableVersionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchDeleteTableVersionWithContext is the same as BatchDeleteTableVersion with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchDeleteTableVersion for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchDeleteTableVersionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchDeleteTableVersionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opBatchGetPartition = "BatchGetPartition"
|
|
|
|
// BatchGetPartitionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the BatchGetPartition operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchGetPartition for more information on using the BatchGetPartition
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the BatchGetPartitionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.BatchGetPartitionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchGetPartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchGetPartitionRequest(input *BatchGetPartitionInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchGetPartitionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opBatchGetPartition,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &BatchGetPartitionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &BatchGetPartitionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchGetPartition API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves partitions in a batch request.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation BatchGetPartition for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchGetPartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchGetPartition(input *BatchGetPartitionInput) (*BatchGetPartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchGetPartitionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchGetPartitionWithContext is the same as BatchGetPartition with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchGetPartition for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchGetPartitionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchGetPartitionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchGetPartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchGetPartitionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opBatchStopJobRun = "BatchStopJobRun"
|
|
|
|
// BatchStopJobRunRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the BatchStopJobRun operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchStopJobRun for more information on using the BatchStopJobRun
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the BatchStopJobRunRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.BatchStopJobRunRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchStopJobRun
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchStopJobRunRequest(input *BatchStopJobRunInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchStopJobRunOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opBatchStopJobRun,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &BatchStopJobRunInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &BatchStopJobRunOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchStopJobRun API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Stops one or more job runs for a specified job definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation BatchStopJobRun for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/BatchStopJobRun
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchStopJobRun(input *BatchStopJobRunInput) (*BatchStopJobRunOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchStopJobRunRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchStopJobRunWithContext is the same as BatchStopJobRun with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchStopJobRun for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) BatchStopJobRunWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchStopJobRunInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchStopJobRunOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchStopJobRunRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateClassifier = "CreateClassifier"
|
|
|
|
// CreateClassifierRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateClassifier operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateClassifier for more information on using the CreateClassifier
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateClassifierRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateClassifierRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateClassifier
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateClassifierRequest(input *CreateClassifierInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateClassifierOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateClassifier,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateClassifierInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateClassifierOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateClassifier API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a classifier in the user's account. This may be a GrokClassifier,
|
|
// an XMLClassifier, or abbrev JsonClassifier, depending on which field of the
|
|
// request is present.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateClassifier for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateClassifier
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateClassifier(input *CreateClassifierInput) (*CreateClassifierOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateClassifierRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateClassifierWithContext is the same as CreateClassifier with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateClassifier for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateClassifierWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateClassifierInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateClassifierOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateClassifierRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateConnection = "CreateConnection"
|
|
|
|
// CreateConnectionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateConnection operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateConnection for more information on using the CreateConnection
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateConnectionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateConnectionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateConnectionRequest(input *CreateConnectionInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateConnectionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateConnection,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateConnectionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateConnectionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateConnection API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a connection definition in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateConnection for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateConnection(input *CreateConnectionInput) (*CreateConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateConnectionWithContext is the same as CreateConnection with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateConnection for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateConnectionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateConnectionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateCrawler = "CreateCrawler"
|
|
|
|
// CreateCrawlerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateCrawler operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateCrawler for more information on using the CreateCrawler
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateCrawlerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateCrawlerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateCrawlerRequest(input *CreateCrawlerInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateCrawlerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateCrawler,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateCrawlerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateCrawlerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateCrawler API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new crawler with specified targets, role, configuration, and optional
|
|
// schedule. At least one crawl target must be specified, in the s3Targets field,
|
|
// the jdbcTargets field, or the DynamoDBTargets field.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateCrawler for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateCrawler(input *CreateCrawlerInput) (*CreateCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateCrawlerWithContext is the same as CreateCrawler with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateCrawler for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateCrawlerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateCrawlerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateDatabase = "CreateDatabase"
|
|
|
|
// CreateDatabaseRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateDatabase operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateDatabase for more information on using the CreateDatabase
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDatabaseRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateDatabaseRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateDatabase
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateDatabaseRequest(input *CreateDatabaseInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDatabaseOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateDatabase,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateDatabaseInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateDatabaseOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateDatabase API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new database in a Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateDatabase for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateDatabase
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateDatabase(input *CreateDatabaseInput) (*CreateDatabaseOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateDatabaseRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateDatabaseWithContext is the same as CreateDatabase with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateDatabase for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateDatabaseWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDatabaseInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDatabaseOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateDatabaseRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateDevEndpoint = "CreateDevEndpoint"
|
|
|
|
// CreateDevEndpointRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateDevEndpoint operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateDevEndpoint for more information on using the CreateDevEndpoint
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDevEndpointRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateDevEndpointRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateDevEndpoint
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateDevEndpointRequest(input *CreateDevEndpointInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDevEndpointOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateDevEndpoint,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateDevEndpointInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateDevEndpointOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateDevEndpoint API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateDevEndpoint for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeAccessDeniedException "AccessDeniedException"
|
|
// Access to a resource was denied.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeIdempotentParameterMismatchException "IdempotentParameterMismatchException"
|
|
// The same unique identifier was associated with two different records.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeValidationException "ValidationException"
|
|
// A value could not be validated.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateDevEndpoint
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateDevEndpoint(input *CreateDevEndpointInput) (*CreateDevEndpointOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateDevEndpointRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateDevEndpointWithContext is the same as CreateDevEndpoint with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateDevEndpoint for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateDevEndpointWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDevEndpointInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDevEndpointOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateDevEndpointRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateJob = "CreateJob"
|
|
|
|
// CreateJobRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateJob operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateJob for more information on using the CreateJob
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateJobRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateJobRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateJob
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateJobRequest(input *CreateJobInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateJobOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateJob,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateJobInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateJobOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateJob API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new job definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateJob for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeIdempotentParameterMismatchException "IdempotentParameterMismatchException"
|
|
// The same unique identifier was associated with two different records.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentModificationException "ConcurrentModificationException"
|
|
// Two processes are trying to modify a resource simultaneously.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateJob
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateJob(input *CreateJobInput) (*CreateJobOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateJobRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateJobWithContext is the same as CreateJob with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateJob for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateJobWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateJobInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateJobOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateJobRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreatePartition = "CreatePartition"
|
|
|
|
// CreatePartitionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreatePartition operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreatePartition for more information on using the CreatePartition
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreatePartitionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreatePartitionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreatePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreatePartitionRequest(input *CreatePartitionInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreatePartitionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreatePartition,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreatePartitionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreatePartitionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreatePartition API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new partition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreatePartition for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreatePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreatePartition(input *CreatePartitionInput) (*CreatePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreatePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreatePartitionWithContext is the same as CreatePartition with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreatePartition for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreatePartitionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreatePartitionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreatePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreatePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateScript = "CreateScript"
|
|
|
|
// CreateScriptRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateScript operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateScript for more information on using the CreateScript
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateScriptRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateScriptRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateScript
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateScriptRequest(input *CreateScriptInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateScriptOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateScript,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateScriptInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateScriptOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateScript API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Transforms a directed acyclic graph (DAG) into code.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateScript for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateScript
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateScript(input *CreateScriptInput) (*CreateScriptOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateScriptRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateScriptWithContext is the same as CreateScript with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateScript for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateScriptWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateScriptInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateScriptOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateScriptRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateSecurityConfiguration = "CreateSecurityConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// CreateSecurityConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateSecurityConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateSecurityConfiguration for more information on using the CreateSecurityConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateSecurityConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateSecurityConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateSecurityConfiguration
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateSecurityConfigurationRequest(input *CreateSecurityConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateSecurityConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateSecurityConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateSecurityConfiguration API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new security configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateSecurityConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateSecurityConfiguration
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateSecurityConfiguration(input *CreateSecurityConfigurationInput) (*CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateSecurityConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateSecurityConfigurationWithContext is the same as CreateSecurityConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateSecurityConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateSecurityConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateSecurityConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateSecurityConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateTable = "CreateTable"
|
|
|
|
// CreateTableRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateTable operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateTable for more information on using the CreateTable
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateTableRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateTableRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateTableRequest(input *CreateTableInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateTableOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateTable,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateTableInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateTableOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateTable API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new table definition in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateTable for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateTable(input *CreateTableInput) (*CreateTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateTableRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateTableWithContext is the same as CreateTable with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateTable for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateTableWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateTableInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateTableRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateTrigger = "CreateTrigger"
|
|
|
|
// CreateTriggerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateTrigger operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateTrigger for more information on using the CreateTrigger
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateTriggerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateTriggerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateTriggerRequest(input *CreateTriggerInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateTriggerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateTrigger,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateTriggerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateTriggerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateTrigger API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new trigger.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateTrigger for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeIdempotentParameterMismatchException "IdempotentParameterMismatchException"
|
|
// The same unique identifier was associated with two different records.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentModificationException "ConcurrentModificationException"
|
|
// Two processes are trying to modify a resource simultaneously.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateTrigger(input *CreateTriggerInput) (*CreateTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateTriggerWithContext is the same as CreateTrigger with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateTrigger for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateTriggerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateTriggerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateUserDefinedFunction = "CreateUserDefinedFunction"
|
|
|
|
// CreateUserDefinedFunctionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateUserDefinedFunction operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateUserDefinedFunction for more information on using the CreateUserDefinedFunction
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateUserDefinedFunctionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateUserDefinedFunctionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateUserDefinedFunction
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateUserDefinedFunctionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateUserDefinedFunction,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateUserDefinedFunctionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateUserDefinedFunction API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new function definition in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation CreateUserDefinedFunction for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeAlreadyExistsException "AlreadyExistsException"
|
|
// A resource to be created or added already exists.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/CreateUserDefinedFunction
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateUserDefinedFunction(input *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput) (*CreateUserDefinedFunctionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateUserDefinedFunctionWithContext is the same as CreateUserDefinedFunction with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateUserDefinedFunction for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) CreateUserDefinedFunctionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateUserDefinedFunctionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteClassifier = "DeleteClassifier"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteClassifierRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteClassifier operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteClassifier for more information on using the DeleteClassifier
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteClassifierRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteClassifierRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteClassifier
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteClassifierRequest(input *DeleteClassifierInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteClassifierOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteClassifier,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteClassifierInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteClassifierOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteClassifier API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Removes a classifier from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteClassifier for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteClassifier
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteClassifier(input *DeleteClassifierInput) (*DeleteClassifierOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteClassifierRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteClassifierWithContext is the same as DeleteClassifier with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteClassifier for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteClassifierWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteClassifierInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteClassifierOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteClassifierRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteConnection = "DeleteConnection"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteConnectionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteConnection operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteConnection for more information on using the DeleteConnection
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteConnectionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteConnectionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteConnectionRequest(input *DeleteConnectionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteConnectionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteConnection,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteConnectionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteConnectionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteConnection API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a connection from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteConnection for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteConnection(input *DeleteConnectionInput) (*DeleteConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteConnectionWithContext is the same as DeleteConnection with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteConnection for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteConnectionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteConnectionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteCrawler = "DeleteCrawler"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteCrawlerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteCrawler operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteCrawler for more information on using the DeleteCrawler
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteCrawlerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteCrawlerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteCrawlerRequest(input *DeleteCrawlerInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteCrawlerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteCrawler,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteCrawlerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteCrawlerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteCrawler API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Removes a specified crawler from the Data Catalog, unless the crawler state
|
|
// is RUNNING.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteCrawler for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeCrawlerRunningException "CrawlerRunningException"
|
|
// The operation cannot be performed because the crawler is already running.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeSchedulerTransitioningException "SchedulerTransitioningException"
|
|
// The specified scheduler is transitioning.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteCrawler(input *DeleteCrawlerInput) (*DeleteCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteCrawlerWithContext is the same as DeleteCrawler with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteCrawler for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteCrawlerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteCrawlerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteDatabase = "DeleteDatabase"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteDatabaseRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteDatabase operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteDatabase for more information on using the DeleteDatabase
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDatabaseRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteDatabaseRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteDatabase
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteDatabaseRequest(input *DeleteDatabaseInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDatabaseOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteDatabase,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteDatabaseInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteDatabaseOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteDatabase API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Removes a specified Database from a Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// After completing this operation, you will no longer have access to the tables
|
|
// (and all table versions and partitions that might belong to the tables) and
|
|
// the user-defined functions in the deleted database. AWS Glue deletes these
|
|
// "orphaned" resources asynchronously in a timely manner, at the discretion
|
|
// of the service.
|
|
//
|
|
// To ensure immediate deletion of all related resources, before calling DeleteDatabase,
|
|
// use DeleteTableVersion or BatchDeleteTableVersion, DeletePartition or BatchDeletePartition,
|
|
// DeleteUserDefinedFunction, and DeleteTable or BatchDeleteTable, to delete
|
|
// any resources that belong to the database.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteDatabase for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteDatabase
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteDatabase(input *DeleteDatabaseInput) (*DeleteDatabaseOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteDatabaseRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteDatabaseWithContext is the same as DeleteDatabase with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteDatabase for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteDatabaseWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDatabaseInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDatabaseOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteDatabaseRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteDevEndpoint = "DeleteDevEndpoint"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteDevEndpointRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteDevEndpoint operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteDevEndpoint for more information on using the DeleteDevEndpoint
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDevEndpointRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteDevEndpointRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteDevEndpoint
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteDevEndpointRequest(input *DeleteDevEndpointInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDevEndpointOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteDevEndpoint,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteDevEndpointInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteDevEndpointOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteDevEndpoint API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a specified DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteDevEndpoint for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteDevEndpoint
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteDevEndpoint(input *DeleteDevEndpointInput) (*DeleteDevEndpointOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteDevEndpointRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteDevEndpointWithContext is the same as DeleteDevEndpoint with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteDevEndpoint for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteDevEndpointWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDevEndpointInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDevEndpointOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteDevEndpointRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteJob = "DeleteJob"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteJobRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteJob operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteJob for more information on using the DeleteJob
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteJobRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteJobRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteJob
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteJobRequest(input *DeleteJobInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteJobOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteJob,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteJobInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteJobOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteJob API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a specified job definition. If the job definition is not found, no
|
|
// exception is thrown.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteJob for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteJob
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteJob(input *DeleteJobInput) (*DeleteJobOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteJobRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteJobWithContext is the same as DeleteJob with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteJob for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteJobWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteJobInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteJobOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteJobRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeletePartition = "DeletePartition"
|
|
|
|
// DeletePartitionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeletePartition operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeletePartition for more information on using the DeletePartition
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeletePartitionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeletePartitionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeletePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeletePartitionRequest(input *DeletePartitionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeletePartitionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeletePartition,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeletePartitionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeletePartitionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeletePartition API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a specified partition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeletePartition for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeletePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeletePartition(input *DeletePartitionInput) (*DeletePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeletePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeletePartitionWithContext is the same as DeletePartition with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeletePartition for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeletePartitionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeletePartitionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeletePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeletePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteSecurityConfiguration = "DeleteSecurityConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteSecurityConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteSecurityConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteSecurityConfiguration for more information on using the DeleteSecurityConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteSecurityConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteSecurityConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteSecurityConfiguration
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteSecurityConfigurationRequest(input *DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteSecurityConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteSecurityConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteSecurityConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteSecurityConfiguration API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a specified security configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteSecurityConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteSecurityConfiguration
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteSecurityConfiguration(input *DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput) (*DeleteSecurityConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteSecurityConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteSecurityConfigurationWithContext is the same as DeleteSecurityConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteSecurityConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteSecurityConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteSecurityConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteSecurityConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteTable = "DeleteTable"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTableRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteTable operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteTable for more information on using the DeleteTable
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteTableRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteTableRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTableRequest(input *DeleteTableInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteTableOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteTable,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteTableInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteTableOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTable API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Removes a table definition from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// After completing this operation, you will no longer have access to the table
|
|
// versions and partitions that belong to the deleted table. AWS Glue deletes
|
|
// these "orphaned" resources asynchronously in a timely manner, at the discretion
|
|
// of the service.
|
|
//
|
|
// To ensure immediate deletion of all related resources, before calling DeleteTable,
|
|
// use DeleteTableVersion or BatchDeleteTableVersion, and DeletePartition or
|
|
// BatchDeletePartition, to delete any resources that belong to the table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteTable for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTable(input *DeleteTableInput) (*DeleteTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteTableRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTableWithContext is the same as DeleteTable with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteTable for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTableWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteTableInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteTableRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteTableVersion = "DeleteTableVersion"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTableVersionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteTableVersion operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteTableVersion for more information on using the DeleteTableVersion
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteTableVersionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteTableVersionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteTableVersion
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTableVersionRequest(input *DeleteTableVersionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteTableVersionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteTableVersion,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteTableVersionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteTableVersionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTableVersion API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a specified version of a table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteTableVersion for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteTableVersion
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTableVersion(input *DeleteTableVersionInput) (*DeleteTableVersionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteTableVersionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTableVersionWithContext is the same as DeleteTableVersion with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteTableVersion for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTableVersionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteTableVersionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteTableVersionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteTableVersionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteTrigger = "DeleteTrigger"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTriggerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteTrigger operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteTrigger for more information on using the DeleteTrigger
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteTriggerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteTriggerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTriggerRequest(input *DeleteTriggerInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteTriggerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteTrigger,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteTriggerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteTriggerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTrigger API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a specified trigger. If the trigger is not found, no exception is
|
|
// thrown.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteTrigger for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentModificationException "ConcurrentModificationException"
|
|
// Two processes are trying to modify a resource simultaneously.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTrigger(input *DeleteTriggerInput) (*DeleteTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteTriggerWithContext is the same as DeleteTrigger with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteTrigger for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteTriggerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteTriggerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteUserDefinedFunction = "DeleteUserDefinedFunction"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteUserDefinedFunctionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteUserDefinedFunction operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteUserDefinedFunction for more information on using the DeleteUserDefinedFunction
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteUserDefinedFunctionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteUserDefinedFunctionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteUserDefinedFunction
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteUserDefinedFunction,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteUserDefinedFunctionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteUserDefinedFunction API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes an existing function definition from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation DeleteUserDefinedFunction for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/DeleteUserDefinedFunction
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteUserDefinedFunction(input *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput) (*DeleteUserDefinedFunctionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteUserDefinedFunctionWithContext is the same as DeleteUserDefinedFunction with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteUserDefinedFunction for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) DeleteUserDefinedFunctionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteUserDefinedFunctionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetCatalogImportStatus = "GetCatalogImportStatus"
|
|
|
|
// GetCatalogImportStatusRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetCatalogImportStatus operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCatalogImportStatus for more information on using the GetCatalogImportStatus
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetCatalogImportStatusRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetCatalogImportStatusRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetCatalogImportStatus
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCatalogImportStatusRequest(input *GetCatalogImportStatusInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetCatalogImportStatusOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetCatalogImportStatus,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetCatalogImportStatusInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetCatalogImportStatusOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCatalogImportStatus API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the status of a migration operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetCatalogImportStatus for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetCatalogImportStatus
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCatalogImportStatus(input *GetCatalogImportStatusInput) (*GetCatalogImportStatusOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetCatalogImportStatusRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCatalogImportStatusWithContext is the same as GetCatalogImportStatus with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCatalogImportStatus for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCatalogImportStatusWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetCatalogImportStatusInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetCatalogImportStatusOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetCatalogImportStatusRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetClassifier = "GetClassifier"
|
|
|
|
// GetClassifierRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetClassifier operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetClassifier for more information on using the GetClassifier
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetClassifierRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetClassifierRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetClassifier
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetClassifierRequest(input *GetClassifierInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetClassifierOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetClassifier,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetClassifierInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetClassifierOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetClassifier API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieve a classifier by name.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetClassifier for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetClassifier
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetClassifier(input *GetClassifierInput) (*GetClassifierOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetClassifierRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetClassifierWithContext is the same as GetClassifier with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetClassifier for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetClassifierWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetClassifierInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetClassifierOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetClassifierRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetClassifiers = "GetClassifiers"
|
|
|
|
// GetClassifiersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetClassifiers operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetClassifiers for more information on using the GetClassifiers
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetClassifiersRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetClassifiersRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetClassifiers
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetClassifiersRequest(input *GetClassifiersInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetClassifiersOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetClassifiers,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetClassifiersInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetClassifiersOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetClassifiers API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Lists all classifier objects in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetClassifiers for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetClassifiers
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetClassifiers(input *GetClassifiersInput) (*GetClassifiersOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetClassifiersRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetClassifiersWithContext is the same as GetClassifiers with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetClassifiers for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetClassifiersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetClassifiersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetClassifiersOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetClassifiersRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetClassifiersPages iterates over the pages of a GetClassifiers operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetClassifiers method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetClassifiers operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetClassifiersPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetClassifiersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetClassifiersPages(input *GetClassifiersInput, fn func(*GetClassifiersOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetClassifiersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetClassifiersPagesWithContext same as GetClassifiersPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetClassifiersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetClassifiersInput, fn func(*GetClassifiersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetClassifiersInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetClassifiersRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetClassifiersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetConnection = "GetConnection"
|
|
|
|
// GetConnectionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetConnection operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetConnection for more information on using the GetConnection
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetConnectionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetConnectionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetConnectionRequest(input *GetConnectionInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetConnectionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetConnection,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetConnectionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetConnectionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetConnection API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves a connection definition from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetConnection for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetConnection(input *GetConnectionInput) (*GetConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetConnectionWithContext is the same as GetConnection with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetConnection for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetConnectionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetConnectionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetConnections = "GetConnections"
|
|
|
|
// GetConnectionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetConnections operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetConnections for more information on using the GetConnections
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetConnectionsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetConnectionsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetConnections
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetConnectionsRequest(input *GetConnectionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetConnectionsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetConnections,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetConnectionsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetConnectionsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetConnections API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves a list of connection definitions from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetConnections for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetConnections
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetConnections(input *GetConnectionsInput) (*GetConnectionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetConnectionsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetConnectionsWithContext is the same as GetConnections with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetConnections for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetConnectionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetConnectionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetConnectionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetConnectionsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetConnectionsPages iterates over the pages of a GetConnections operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetConnections method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetConnections operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetConnectionsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetConnectionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetConnectionsPages(input *GetConnectionsInput, fn func(*GetConnectionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetConnectionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetConnectionsPagesWithContext same as GetConnectionsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetConnectionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetConnectionsInput, fn func(*GetConnectionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetConnectionsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetConnectionsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetConnectionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetCrawler = "GetCrawler"
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetCrawler operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCrawler for more information on using the GetCrawler
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetCrawlerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetCrawlerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlerRequest(input *GetCrawlerInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetCrawlerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetCrawler,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetCrawlerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetCrawlerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawler API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves metadata for a specified crawler.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetCrawler for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawler(input *GetCrawlerInput) (*GetCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlerWithContext is the same as GetCrawler with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCrawler for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetCrawlerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetCrawlerMetrics = "GetCrawlerMetrics"
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlerMetricsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetCrawlerMetrics operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCrawlerMetrics for more information on using the GetCrawlerMetrics
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetCrawlerMetricsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetCrawlerMetricsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetCrawlerMetrics
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlerMetricsRequest(input *GetCrawlerMetricsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetCrawlerMetricsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetCrawlerMetrics,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetCrawlerMetricsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetCrawlerMetricsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlerMetrics API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves metrics about specified crawlers.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetCrawlerMetrics for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetCrawlerMetrics
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlerMetrics(input *GetCrawlerMetricsInput) (*GetCrawlerMetricsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetCrawlerMetricsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlerMetricsWithContext is the same as GetCrawlerMetrics with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCrawlerMetrics for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlerMetricsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetCrawlerMetricsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetCrawlerMetricsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetCrawlerMetricsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlerMetricsPages iterates over the pages of a GetCrawlerMetrics operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCrawlerMetrics method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetCrawlerMetrics operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetCrawlerMetricsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetCrawlerMetricsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlerMetricsPages(input *GetCrawlerMetricsInput, fn func(*GetCrawlerMetricsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetCrawlerMetricsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlerMetricsPagesWithContext same as GetCrawlerMetricsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlerMetricsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetCrawlerMetricsInput, fn func(*GetCrawlerMetricsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetCrawlerMetricsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetCrawlerMetricsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetCrawlerMetricsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetCrawlers = "GetCrawlers"
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetCrawlers operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCrawlers for more information on using the GetCrawlers
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetCrawlersRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetCrawlersRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetCrawlers
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlersRequest(input *GetCrawlersInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetCrawlersOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetCrawlers,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetCrawlersInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetCrawlersOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlers API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves metadata for all crawlers defined in the customer account.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetCrawlers for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetCrawlers
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlers(input *GetCrawlersInput) (*GetCrawlersOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetCrawlersRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlersWithContext is the same as GetCrawlers with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCrawlers for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetCrawlersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetCrawlersOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetCrawlersRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlersPages iterates over the pages of a GetCrawlers operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetCrawlers method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetCrawlers operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetCrawlersPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetCrawlersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlersPages(input *GetCrawlersInput, fn func(*GetCrawlersOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetCrawlersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetCrawlersPagesWithContext same as GetCrawlersPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetCrawlersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetCrawlersInput, fn func(*GetCrawlersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetCrawlersInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetCrawlersRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetCrawlersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings = "GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings"
|
|
|
|
// GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings for more information on using the GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest(input *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the security configuration for a specified catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings(input *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) (*GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsWithContext is the same as GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetDatabase = "GetDatabase"
|
|
|
|
// GetDatabaseRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetDatabase operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDatabase for more information on using the GetDatabase
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetDatabaseRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetDatabaseRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDatabase
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDatabaseRequest(input *GetDatabaseInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetDatabaseOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetDatabase,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetDatabaseInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetDatabaseOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDatabase API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the definition of a specified database.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetDatabase for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDatabase
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDatabase(input *GetDatabaseInput) (*GetDatabaseOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDatabaseRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDatabaseWithContext is the same as GetDatabase with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDatabase for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDatabaseWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetDatabaseInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetDatabaseOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDatabaseRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetDatabases = "GetDatabases"
|
|
|
|
// GetDatabasesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetDatabases operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDatabases for more information on using the GetDatabases
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetDatabasesRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetDatabasesRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDatabases
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDatabasesRequest(input *GetDatabasesInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetDatabasesOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetDatabases,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetDatabasesInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetDatabasesOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDatabases API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves all Databases defined in a given Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetDatabases for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDatabases
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDatabases(input *GetDatabasesInput) (*GetDatabasesOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDatabasesRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDatabasesWithContext is the same as GetDatabases with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDatabases for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDatabasesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetDatabasesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetDatabasesOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDatabasesRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDatabasesPages iterates over the pages of a GetDatabases operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDatabases method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetDatabases operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetDatabasesPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetDatabasesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDatabasesPages(input *GetDatabasesInput, fn func(*GetDatabasesOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetDatabasesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDatabasesPagesWithContext same as GetDatabasesPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDatabasesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetDatabasesInput, fn func(*GetDatabasesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetDatabasesInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetDatabasesRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetDatabasesOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetDataflowGraph = "GetDataflowGraph"
|
|
|
|
// GetDataflowGraphRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetDataflowGraph operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDataflowGraph for more information on using the GetDataflowGraph
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetDataflowGraphRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetDataflowGraphRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDataflowGraph
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDataflowGraphRequest(input *GetDataflowGraphInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetDataflowGraphOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetDataflowGraph,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetDataflowGraphInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetDataflowGraphOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDataflowGraph API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Transforms a Python script into a directed acyclic graph (DAG).
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetDataflowGraph for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDataflowGraph
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDataflowGraph(input *GetDataflowGraphInput) (*GetDataflowGraphOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDataflowGraphRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDataflowGraphWithContext is the same as GetDataflowGraph with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDataflowGraph for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDataflowGraphWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetDataflowGraphInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetDataflowGraphOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDataflowGraphRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetDevEndpoint = "GetDevEndpoint"
|
|
|
|
// GetDevEndpointRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetDevEndpoint operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDevEndpoint for more information on using the GetDevEndpoint
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetDevEndpointRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetDevEndpointRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDevEndpoint
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDevEndpointRequest(input *GetDevEndpointInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetDevEndpointOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetDevEndpoint,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetDevEndpointInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetDevEndpointOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDevEndpoint API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves information about a specified DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetDevEndpoint for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDevEndpoint
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDevEndpoint(input *GetDevEndpointInput) (*GetDevEndpointOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDevEndpointRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDevEndpointWithContext is the same as GetDevEndpoint with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDevEndpoint for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDevEndpointWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetDevEndpointInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetDevEndpointOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDevEndpointRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetDevEndpoints = "GetDevEndpoints"
|
|
|
|
// GetDevEndpointsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetDevEndpoints operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDevEndpoints for more information on using the GetDevEndpoints
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetDevEndpointsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetDevEndpointsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDevEndpoints
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDevEndpointsRequest(input *GetDevEndpointsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetDevEndpointsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetDevEndpoints,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetDevEndpointsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetDevEndpointsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDevEndpoints API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves all the DevEndpoints in this AWS account.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetDevEndpoints for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetDevEndpoints
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDevEndpoints(input *GetDevEndpointsInput) (*GetDevEndpointsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDevEndpointsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDevEndpointsWithContext is the same as GetDevEndpoints with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDevEndpoints for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDevEndpointsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetDevEndpointsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetDevEndpointsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetDevEndpointsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDevEndpointsPages iterates over the pages of a GetDevEndpoints operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetDevEndpoints method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetDevEndpoints operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetDevEndpointsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetDevEndpointsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDevEndpointsPages(input *GetDevEndpointsInput, fn func(*GetDevEndpointsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetDevEndpointsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetDevEndpointsPagesWithContext same as GetDevEndpointsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetDevEndpointsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetDevEndpointsInput, fn func(*GetDevEndpointsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetDevEndpointsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetDevEndpointsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetDevEndpointsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetJob = "GetJob"
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetJob operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJob for more information on using the GetJob
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetJobRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetJobRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetJob
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRequest(input *GetJobInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetJobOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetJob,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetJobInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetJobOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJob API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves an existing job definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetJob for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetJob
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJob(input *GetJobInput) (*GetJobOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetJobRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobWithContext is the same as GetJob with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJob for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetJobInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetJobOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetJobRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetJobRun = "GetJobRun"
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRunRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetJobRun operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJobRun for more information on using the GetJobRun
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetJobRunRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetJobRunRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetJobRun
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRunRequest(input *GetJobRunInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetJobRunOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetJobRun,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetJobRunInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetJobRunOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRun API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the metadata for a given job run.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetJobRun for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetJobRun
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRun(input *GetJobRunInput) (*GetJobRunOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetJobRunRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRunWithContext is the same as GetJobRun with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJobRun for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRunWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetJobRunInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetJobRunOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetJobRunRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetJobRuns = "GetJobRuns"
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRunsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetJobRuns operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJobRuns for more information on using the GetJobRuns
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetJobRunsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetJobRunsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetJobRuns
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRunsRequest(input *GetJobRunsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetJobRunsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetJobRuns,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetJobRunsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetJobRunsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRuns API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves metadata for all runs of a given job definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetJobRuns for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetJobRuns
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRuns(input *GetJobRunsInput) (*GetJobRunsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetJobRunsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRunsWithContext is the same as GetJobRuns with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJobRuns for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRunsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetJobRunsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetJobRunsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetJobRunsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRunsPages iterates over the pages of a GetJobRuns operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJobRuns method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetJobRuns operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetJobRunsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetJobRunsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRunsPages(input *GetJobRunsInput, fn func(*GetJobRunsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetJobRunsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobRunsPagesWithContext same as GetJobRunsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobRunsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetJobRunsInput, fn func(*GetJobRunsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetJobRunsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetJobRunsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetJobRunsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetJobs = "GetJobs"
|
|
|
|
// GetJobsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetJobs operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJobs for more information on using the GetJobs
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetJobsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetJobsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetJobs
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobsRequest(input *GetJobsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetJobsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetJobs,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetJobsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetJobsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobs API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves all current job definitions.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetJobs for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetJobs
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobs(input *GetJobsInput) (*GetJobsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetJobsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobsWithContext is the same as GetJobs with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJobs for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetJobsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetJobsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetJobsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobsPages iterates over the pages of a GetJobs operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetJobs method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetJobs operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetJobsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetJobsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobsPages(input *GetJobsInput, fn func(*GetJobsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetJobsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetJobsPagesWithContext same as GetJobsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetJobsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetJobsInput, fn func(*GetJobsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetJobsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetJobsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetJobsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetMapping = "GetMapping"
|
|
|
|
// GetMappingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetMapping operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetMapping for more information on using the GetMapping
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetMappingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetMappingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetMapping
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetMappingRequest(input *GetMappingInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetMappingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetMapping,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetMappingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetMappingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetMapping API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates mappings.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetMapping for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetMapping
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetMapping(input *GetMappingInput) (*GetMappingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetMappingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetMappingWithContext is the same as GetMapping with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetMapping for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetMappingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetMappingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetMappingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetMappingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetPartition = "GetPartition"
|
|
|
|
// GetPartitionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetPartition operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPartition for more information on using the GetPartition
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetPartitionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetPartitionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetPartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPartitionRequest(input *GetPartitionInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetPartitionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetPartition,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetPartitionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetPartitionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPartition API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves information about a specified partition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetPartition for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetPartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPartition(input *GetPartitionInput) (*GetPartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetPartitionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPartitionWithContext is the same as GetPartition with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPartition for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPartitionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetPartitionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetPartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetPartitionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetPartitions = "GetPartitions"
|
|
|
|
// GetPartitionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetPartitions operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPartitions for more information on using the GetPartitions
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetPartitionsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetPartitionsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetPartitions
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPartitionsRequest(input *GetPartitionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetPartitionsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetPartitions,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetPartitionsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetPartitionsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPartitions API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves information about the partitions in a table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetPartitions for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetPartitions
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPartitions(input *GetPartitionsInput) (*GetPartitionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetPartitionsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPartitionsWithContext is the same as GetPartitions with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPartitions for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPartitionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetPartitionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetPartitionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetPartitionsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPartitionsPages iterates over the pages of a GetPartitions operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPartitions method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetPartitions operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetPartitionsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetPartitionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPartitionsPages(input *GetPartitionsInput, fn func(*GetPartitionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetPartitionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPartitionsPagesWithContext same as GetPartitionsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPartitionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetPartitionsInput, fn func(*GetPartitionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetPartitionsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetPartitionsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetPartitionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetPlan = "GetPlan"
|
|
|
|
// GetPlanRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetPlan operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPlan for more information on using the GetPlan
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetPlanRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetPlanRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetPlan
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPlanRequest(input *GetPlanInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetPlanOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetPlan,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetPlanInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetPlanOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPlan API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gets code to perform a specified mapping.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetPlan for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetPlan
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPlan(input *GetPlanInput) (*GetPlanOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetPlanRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPlanWithContext is the same as GetPlan with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPlan for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetPlanWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetPlanInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetPlanOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetPlanRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetSecurityConfiguration = "GetSecurityConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// GetSecurityConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetSecurityConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetSecurityConfiguration for more information on using the GetSecurityConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetSecurityConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetSecurityConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetSecurityConfiguration
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetSecurityConfigurationRequest(input *GetSecurityConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetSecurityConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetSecurityConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetSecurityConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetSecurityConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetSecurityConfiguration API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves a specified security configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetSecurityConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetSecurityConfiguration
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetSecurityConfiguration(input *GetSecurityConfigurationInput) (*GetSecurityConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetSecurityConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetSecurityConfigurationWithContext is the same as GetSecurityConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetSecurityConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetSecurityConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetSecurityConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetSecurityConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetSecurityConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetSecurityConfigurations = "GetSecurityConfigurations"
|
|
|
|
// GetSecurityConfigurationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetSecurityConfigurations operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetSecurityConfigurations for more information on using the GetSecurityConfigurations
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetSecurityConfigurationsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetSecurityConfigurationsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetSecurityConfigurations
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetSecurityConfigurationsRequest(input *GetSecurityConfigurationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetSecurityConfigurations,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetSecurityConfigurationsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetSecurityConfigurations API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves a list of all security configurations.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetSecurityConfigurations for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetSecurityConfigurations
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetSecurityConfigurations(input *GetSecurityConfigurationsInput) (*GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetSecurityConfigurationsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetSecurityConfigurationsWithContext is the same as GetSecurityConfigurations with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetSecurityConfigurations for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetSecurityConfigurationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetSecurityConfigurationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetSecurityConfigurationsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetTable = "GetTable"
|
|
|
|
// GetTableRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetTable operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTable for more information on using the GetTable
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetTableRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetTableRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableRequest(input *GetTableInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetTableOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetTable,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetTableInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetTableOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTable API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the Table definition in a Data Catalog for a specified table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetTable for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTable(input *GetTableInput) (*GetTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTableRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTableWithContext is the same as GetTable with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTable for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTableInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTableRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetTableVersion = "GetTableVersion"
|
|
|
|
// GetTableVersionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetTableVersion operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTableVersion for more information on using the GetTableVersion
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetTableVersionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetTableVersionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTableVersion
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableVersionRequest(input *GetTableVersionInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetTableVersionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetTableVersion,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetTableVersionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetTableVersionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTableVersion API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves a specified version of a table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetTableVersion for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTableVersion
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableVersion(input *GetTableVersionInput) (*GetTableVersionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTableVersionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTableVersionWithContext is the same as GetTableVersion with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTableVersion for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableVersionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTableVersionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetTableVersionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTableVersionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetTableVersions = "GetTableVersions"
|
|
|
|
// GetTableVersionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetTableVersions operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTableVersions for more information on using the GetTableVersions
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetTableVersionsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetTableVersionsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTableVersions
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableVersionsRequest(input *GetTableVersionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetTableVersionsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetTableVersions,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetTableVersionsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetTableVersionsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTableVersions API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves a list of strings that identify available versions of a specified
|
|
// table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetTableVersions for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTableVersions
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableVersions(input *GetTableVersionsInput) (*GetTableVersionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTableVersionsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTableVersionsWithContext is the same as GetTableVersions with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTableVersions for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableVersionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTableVersionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetTableVersionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTableVersionsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTableVersionsPages iterates over the pages of a GetTableVersions operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTableVersions method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetTableVersions operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetTableVersionsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetTableVersionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableVersionsPages(input *GetTableVersionsInput, fn func(*GetTableVersionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetTableVersionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTableVersionsPagesWithContext same as GetTableVersionsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTableVersionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTableVersionsInput, fn func(*GetTableVersionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetTableVersionsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetTableVersionsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetTableVersionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetTables = "GetTables"
|
|
|
|
// GetTablesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetTables operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTables for more information on using the GetTables
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetTablesRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetTablesRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTables
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTablesRequest(input *GetTablesInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetTablesOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetTables,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetTablesInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetTablesOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTables API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the definitions of some or all of the tables in a given Database.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetTables for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTables
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTables(input *GetTablesInput) (*GetTablesOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTablesRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTablesWithContext is the same as GetTables with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTables for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTablesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTablesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetTablesOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTablesRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTablesPages iterates over the pages of a GetTables operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTables method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetTables operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetTablesPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetTablesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTablesPages(input *GetTablesInput, fn func(*GetTablesOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetTablesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTablesPagesWithContext same as GetTablesPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTablesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTablesInput, fn func(*GetTablesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetTablesInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetTablesRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetTablesOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetTrigger = "GetTrigger"
|
|
|
|
// GetTriggerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetTrigger operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTrigger for more information on using the GetTrigger
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetTriggerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetTriggerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTriggerRequest(input *GetTriggerInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetTriggerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetTrigger,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetTriggerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetTriggerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTrigger API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the definition of a trigger.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetTrigger for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTrigger(input *GetTriggerInput) (*GetTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTriggerWithContext is the same as GetTrigger with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTrigger for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTriggerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTriggerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetTriggers = "GetTriggers"
|
|
|
|
// GetTriggersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetTriggers operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTriggers for more information on using the GetTriggers
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetTriggersRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetTriggersRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTriggers
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTriggersRequest(input *GetTriggersInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetTriggersOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetTriggers,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetTriggersInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetTriggersOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTriggers API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gets all the triggers associated with a job.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetTriggers for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetTriggers
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTriggers(input *GetTriggersInput) (*GetTriggersOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTriggersRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTriggersWithContext is the same as GetTriggers with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTriggers for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTriggersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTriggersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetTriggersOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetTriggersRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTriggersPages iterates over the pages of a GetTriggers operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetTriggers method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetTriggers operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetTriggersPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetTriggersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTriggersPages(input *GetTriggersInput, fn func(*GetTriggersOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetTriggersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetTriggersPagesWithContext same as GetTriggersPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetTriggersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetTriggersInput, fn func(*GetTriggersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetTriggersInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetTriggersRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetTriggersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetUserDefinedFunction = "GetUserDefinedFunction"
|
|
|
|
// GetUserDefinedFunctionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetUserDefinedFunction operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetUserDefinedFunction for more information on using the GetUserDefinedFunction
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetUserDefinedFunctionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetUserDefinedFunctionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetUserDefinedFunction
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetUserDefinedFunction,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetUserDefinedFunctionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetUserDefinedFunction API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves a specified function definition from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetUserDefinedFunction for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetUserDefinedFunction
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetUserDefinedFunction(input *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput) (*GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetUserDefinedFunctionWithContext is the same as GetUserDefinedFunction with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetUserDefinedFunction for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetUserDefinedFunctionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetUserDefinedFunctions = "GetUserDefinedFunctions"
|
|
|
|
// GetUserDefinedFunctionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetUserDefinedFunctions operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetUserDefinedFunctions for more information on using the GetUserDefinedFunctions
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetUserDefinedFunctionsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetUserDefinedFunctionsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetUserDefinedFunctions
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetUserDefinedFunctionsRequest(input *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetUserDefinedFunctions,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetUserDefinedFunctions API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves a multiple function definitions from the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation GetUserDefinedFunctions for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/GetUserDefinedFunctions
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetUserDefinedFunctions(input *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) (*GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetUserDefinedFunctionsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetUserDefinedFunctionsWithContext is the same as GetUserDefinedFunctions with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetUserDefinedFunctions for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetUserDefinedFunctionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetUserDefinedFunctionsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetUserDefinedFunctionsPages iterates over the pages of a GetUserDefinedFunctions operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetUserDefinedFunctions method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetUserDefinedFunctions operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.GetUserDefinedFunctionsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetUserDefinedFunctionsPages(input *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput, fn func(*GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.GetUserDefinedFunctionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetUserDefinedFunctionsPagesWithContext same as GetUserDefinedFunctionsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) GetUserDefinedFunctionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput, fn func(*GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.GetUserDefinedFunctionsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opImportCatalogToGlue = "ImportCatalogToGlue"
|
|
|
|
// ImportCatalogToGlueRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ImportCatalogToGlue operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ImportCatalogToGlue for more information on using the ImportCatalogToGlue
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ImportCatalogToGlueRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ImportCatalogToGlueRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/ImportCatalogToGlue
|
|
func (c *Glue) ImportCatalogToGlueRequest(input *ImportCatalogToGlueInput) (req *request.Request, output *ImportCatalogToGlueOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opImportCatalogToGlue,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ImportCatalogToGlueInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ImportCatalogToGlueOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ImportCatalogToGlue API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Imports an existing Athena Data Catalog to AWS Glue
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation ImportCatalogToGlue for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/ImportCatalogToGlue
|
|
func (c *Glue) ImportCatalogToGlue(input *ImportCatalogToGlueInput) (*ImportCatalogToGlueOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ImportCatalogToGlueRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ImportCatalogToGlueWithContext is the same as ImportCatalogToGlue with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ImportCatalogToGlue for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) ImportCatalogToGlueWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ImportCatalogToGlueInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ImportCatalogToGlueOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ImportCatalogToGlueRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings = "PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings"
|
|
|
|
// PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings for more information on using the PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings
|
|
func (c *Glue) PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest(input *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the security configuration for a specified catalog. Once the configuration
|
|
// has been set, the specified encryption is applied to every catalog write
|
|
// thereafter.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings
|
|
func (c *Glue) PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings(input *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) (*PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsWithContext is the same as PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettings for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opResetJobBookmark = "ResetJobBookmark"
|
|
|
|
// ResetJobBookmarkRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ResetJobBookmark operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ResetJobBookmark for more information on using the ResetJobBookmark
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ResetJobBookmarkRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ResetJobBookmarkRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/ResetJobBookmark
|
|
func (c *Glue) ResetJobBookmarkRequest(input *ResetJobBookmarkInput) (req *request.Request, output *ResetJobBookmarkOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opResetJobBookmark,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ResetJobBookmarkInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ResetJobBookmarkOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ResetJobBookmark API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Resets a bookmark entry.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation ResetJobBookmark for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/ResetJobBookmark
|
|
func (c *Glue) ResetJobBookmark(input *ResetJobBookmarkInput) (*ResetJobBookmarkOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ResetJobBookmarkRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ResetJobBookmarkWithContext is the same as ResetJobBookmark with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ResetJobBookmark for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) ResetJobBookmarkWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetJobBookmarkInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ResetJobBookmarkOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ResetJobBookmarkRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStartCrawler = "StartCrawler"
|
|
|
|
// StartCrawlerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StartCrawler operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartCrawler for more information on using the StartCrawler
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StartCrawlerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StartCrawlerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StartCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartCrawlerRequest(input *StartCrawlerInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartCrawlerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStartCrawler,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StartCrawlerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StartCrawlerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartCrawler API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Starts a crawl using the specified crawler, regardless of what is scheduled.
|
|
// If the crawler is already running, returns a CrawlerRunningException (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-api-exceptions.html#aws-glue-api-exceptions-CrawlerRunningException).
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation StartCrawler for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeCrawlerRunningException "CrawlerRunningException"
|
|
// The operation cannot be performed because the crawler is already running.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StartCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartCrawler(input *StartCrawlerInput) (*StartCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartCrawlerWithContext is the same as StartCrawler with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartCrawler for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartCrawlerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartCrawlerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStartCrawlerSchedule = "StartCrawlerSchedule"
|
|
|
|
// StartCrawlerScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StartCrawlerSchedule operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartCrawlerSchedule for more information on using the StartCrawlerSchedule
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StartCrawlerScheduleRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StartCrawlerScheduleRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StartCrawlerSchedule
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartCrawlerScheduleRequest(input *StartCrawlerScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartCrawlerScheduleOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStartCrawlerSchedule,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StartCrawlerScheduleInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StartCrawlerScheduleOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartCrawlerSchedule API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Changes the schedule state of the specified crawler to SCHEDULED, unless
|
|
// the crawler is already running or the schedule state is already SCHEDULED.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation StartCrawlerSchedule for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeSchedulerRunningException "SchedulerRunningException"
|
|
// The specified scheduler is already running.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeSchedulerTransitioningException "SchedulerTransitioningException"
|
|
// The specified scheduler is transitioning.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNoScheduleException "NoScheduleException"
|
|
// There is no applicable schedule.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StartCrawlerSchedule
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartCrawlerSchedule(input *StartCrawlerScheduleInput) (*StartCrawlerScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartCrawlerScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartCrawlerScheduleWithContext is the same as StartCrawlerSchedule with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartCrawlerSchedule for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartCrawlerScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartCrawlerScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartCrawlerScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartCrawlerScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStartJobRun = "StartJobRun"
|
|
|
|
// StartJobRunRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StartJobRun operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartJobRun for more information on using the StartJobRun
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StartJobRunRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StartJobRunRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StartJobRun
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartJobRunRequest(input *StartJobRunInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartJobRunOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStartJobRun,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StartJobRunInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StartJobRunOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartJobRun API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Starts a job run using a job definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation StartJobRun for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentRunsExceededException "ConcurrentRunsExceededException"
|
|
// Too many jobs are being run concurrently.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StartJobRun
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartJobRun(input *StartJobRunInput) (*StartJobRunOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartJobRunRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartJobRunWithContext is the same as StartJobRun with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartJobRun for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartJobRunWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartJobRunInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartJobRunOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartJobRunRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStartTrigger = "StartTrigger"
|
|
|
|
// StartTriggerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StartTrigger operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartTrigger for more information on using the StartTrigger
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StartTriggerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StartTriggerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StartTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartTriggerRequest(input *StartTriggerInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartTriggerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStartTrigger,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StartTriggerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StartTriggerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartTrigger API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Starts an existing trigger. See Triggering Jobs (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/trigger-job.html)
|
|
// for information about how different types of trigger are started.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation StartTrigger for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentRunsExceededException "ConcurrentRunsExceededException"
|
|
// Too many jobs are being run concurrently.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StartTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartTrigger(input *StartTriggerInput) (*StartTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartTriggerWithContext is the same as StartTrigger with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartTrigger for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) StartTriggerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartTriggerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStopCrawler = "StopCrawler"
|
|
|
|
// StopCrawlerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StopCrawler operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StopCrawler for more information on using the StopCrawler
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StopCrawlerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StopCrawlerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StopCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopCrawlerRequest(input *StopCrawlerInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopCrawlerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStopCrawler,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StopCrawlerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StopCrawlerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StopCrawler API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// If the specified crawler is running, stops the crawl.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation StopCrawler for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeCrawlerNotRunningException "CrawlerNotRunningException"
|
|
// The specified crawler is not running.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeCrawlerStoppingException "CrawlerStoppingException"
|
|
// The specified crawler is stopping.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StopCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopCrawler(input *StopCrawlerInput) (*StopCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StopCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StopCrawlerWithContext is the same as StopCrawler with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StopCrawler for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopCrawlerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopCrawlerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StopCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStopCrawlerSchedule = "StopCrawlerSchedule"
|
|
|
|
// StopCrawlerScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StopCrawlerSchedule operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StopCrawlerSchedule for more information on using the StopCrawlerSchedule
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StopCrawlerScheduleRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StopCrawlerScheduleRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StopCrawlerSchedule
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopCrawlerScheduleRequest(input *StopCrawlerScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopCrawlerScheduleOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStopCrawlerSchedule,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StopCrawlerScheduleInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StopCrawlerScheduleOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StopCrawlerSchedule API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the schedule state of the specified crawler to NOT_SCHEDULED, but does
|
|
// not stop the crawler if it is already running.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation StopCrawlerSchedule for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeSchedulerNotRunningException "SchedulerNotRunningException"
|
|
// The specified scheduler is not running.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeSchedulerTransitioningException "SchedulerTransitioningException"
|
|
// The specified scheduler is transitioning.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StopCrawlerSchedule
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopCrawlerSchedule(input *StopCrawlerScheduleInput) (*StopCrawlerScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StopCrawlerScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StopCrawlerScheduleWithContext is the same as StopCrawlerSchedule with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StopCrawlerSchedule for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopCrawlerScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopCrawlerScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopCrawlerScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StopCrawlerScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStopTrigger = "StopTrigger"
|
|
|
|
// StopTriggerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StopTrigger operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StopTrigger for more information on using the StopTrigger
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StopTriggerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StopTriggerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StopTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopTriggerRequest(input *StopTriggerInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopTriggerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStopTrigger,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StopTriggerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StopTriggerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StopTrigger API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Stops a specified trigger.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation StopTrigger for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentModificationException "ConcurrentModificationException"
|
|
// Two processes are trying to modify a resource simultaneously.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/StopTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopTrigger(input *StopTriggerInput) (*StopTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StopTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StopTriggerWithContext is the same as StopTrigger with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StopTrigger for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) StopTriggerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopTriggerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StopTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateClassifier = "UpdateClassifier"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateClassifierRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateClassifier operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateClassifier for more information on using the UpdateClassifier
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateClassifierRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateClassifierRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateClassifier
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateClassifierRequest(input *UpdateClassifierInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateClassifierOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateClassifier,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateClassifierInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateClassifierOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateClassifier API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Modifies an existing classifier (a GrokClassifier, XMLClassifier, or JsonClassifier,
|
|
// depending on which field is present).
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateClassifier for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeVersionMismatchException "VersionMismatchException"
|
|
// There was a version conflict.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateClassifier
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateClassifier(input *UpdateClassifierInput) (*UpdateClassifierOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateClassifierRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateClassifierWithContext is the same as UpdateClassifier with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateClassifier for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateClassifierWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateClassifierInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateClassifierOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateClassifierRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateConnection = "UpdateConnection"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateConnectionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateConnection operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateConnection for more information on using the UpdateConnection
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateConnectionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateConnectionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateConnectionRequest(input *UpdateConnectionInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateConnectionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateConnection,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateConnectionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateConnectionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateConnection API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates a connection definition in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateConnection for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateConnection
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateConnection(input *UpdateConnectionInput) (*UpdateConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateConnectionWithContext is the same as UpdateConnection with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateConnection for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateConnectionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateConnectionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateConnectionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateConnectionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateCrawler = "UpdateCrawler"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateCrawlerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateCrawler operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateCrawler for more information on using the UpdateCrawler
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateCrawlerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateCrawlerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateCrawlerRequest(input *UpdateCrawlerInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateCrawlerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateCrawler,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateCrawlerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateCrawlerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateCrawler API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates a crawler. If a crawler is running, you must stop it using StopCrawler
|
|
// before updating it.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateCrawler for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeVersionMismatchException "VersionMismatchException"
|
|
// There was a version conflict.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeCrawlerRunningException "CrawlerRunningException"
|
|
// The operation cannot be performed because the crawler is already running.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateCrawler
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateCrawler(input *UpdateCrawlerInput) (*UpdateCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateCrawlerWithContext is the same as UpdateCrawler with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateCrawler for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateCrawlerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateCrawlerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateCrawlerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateCrawlerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateCrawlerSchedule = "UpdateCrawlerSchedule"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateCrawlerScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateCrawlerSchedule operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateCrawlerSchedule for more information on using the UpdateCrawlerSchedule
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateCrawlerScheduleRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateCrawlerScheduleRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateCrawlerSchedule
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateCrawlerScheduleRequest(input *UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateCrawlerScheduleOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateCrawlerSchedule,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateCrawlerScheduleOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateCrawlerSchedule API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates the schedule of a crawler using a cron expression.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateCrawlerSchedule for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeVersionMismatchException "VersionMismatchException"
|
|
// There was a version conflict.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeSchedulerTransitioningException "SchedulerTransitioningException"
|
|
// The specified scheduler is transitioning.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateCrawlerSchedule
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateCrawlerSchedule(input *UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput) (*UpdateCrawlerScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateCrawlerScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateCrawlerScheduleWithContext is the same as UpdateCrawlerSchedule with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateCrawlerSchedule for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateCrawlerScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateCrawlerScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateCrawlerScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateDatabase = "UpdateDatabase"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateDatabaseRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateDatabase operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateDatabase for more information on using the UpdateDatabase
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateDatabaseRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateDatabaseRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateDatabase
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateDatabaseRequest(input *UpdateDatabaseInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateDatabaseOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateDatabase,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateDatabaseInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateDatabaseOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateDatabase API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates an existing database definition in a Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateDatabase for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateDatabase
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateDatabase(input *UpdateDatabaseInput) (*UpdateDatabaseOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateDatabaseRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateDatabaseWithContext is the same as UpdateDatabase with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateDatabase for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateDatabaseWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateDatabaseInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateDatabaseOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateDatabaseRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateDevEndpoint = "UpdateDevEndpoint"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateDevEndpointRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateDevEndpoint operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateDevEndpoint for more information on using the UpdateDevEndpoint
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateDevEndpointRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateDevEndpointRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateDevEndpoint
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateDevEndpointRequest(input *UpdateDevEndpointInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateDevEndpointOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateDevEndpoint,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateDevEndpointInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateDevEndpointOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateDevEndpoint API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates a specified DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateDevEndpoint for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeValidationException "ValidationException"
|
|
// A value could not be validated.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateDevEndpoint
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateDevEndpoint(input *UpdateDevEndpointInput) (*UpdateDevEndpointOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateDevEndpointRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateDevEndpointWithContext is the same as UpdateDevEndpoint with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateDevEndpoint for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateDevEndpointWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateDevEndpointInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateDevEndpointOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateDevEndpointRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateJob = "UpdateJob"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateJobRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateJob operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateJob for more information on using the UpdateJob
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateJobRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateJobRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateJob
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateJobRequest(input *UpdateJobInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateJobOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateJob,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateJobInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateJobOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateJob API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates an existing job definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateJob for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentModificationException "ConcurrentModificationException"
|
|
// Two processes are trying to modify a resource simultaneously.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateJob
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateJob(input *UpdateJobInput) (*UpdateJobOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateJobRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateJobWithContext is the same as UpdateJob with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateJob for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateJobWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateJobInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateJobOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateJobRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdatePartition = "UpdatePartition"
|
|
|
|
// UpdatePartitionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdatePartition operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdatePartition for more information on using the UpdatePartition
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdatePartitionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdatePartitionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdatePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdatePartitionRequest(input *UpdatePartitionInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdatePartitionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdatePartition,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdatePartitionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdatePartitionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdatePartition API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates a partition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdatePartition for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdatePartition
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdatePartition(input *UpdatePartitionInput) (*UpdatePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdatePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdatePartitionWithContext is the same as UpdatePartition with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdatePartition for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdatePartitionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdatePartitionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdatePartitionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdatePartitionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateTable = "UpdateTable"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateTableRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateTable operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateTable for more information on using the UpdateTable
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateTableRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateTableRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateTableRequest(input *UpdateTableInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateTableOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateTable,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateTableInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateTableOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateTable API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates a metadata table in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateTable for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentModificationException "ConcurrentModificationException"
|
|
// Two processes are trying to modify a resource simultaneously.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeResourceNumberLimitExceededException "ResourceNumberLimitExceededException"
|
|
// A resource numerical limit was exceeded.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateTable
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateTable(input *UpdateTableInput) (*UpdateTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateTableRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateTableWithContext is the same as UpdateTable with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateTable for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateTableWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateTableInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateTableOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateTableRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateTrigger = "UpdateTrigger"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateTriggerRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateTrigger operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateTrigger for more information on using the UpdateTrigger
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateTriggerRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateTriggerRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateTriggerRequest(input *UpdateTriggerInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateTriggerOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateTrigger,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateTriggerInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateTriggerOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateTrigger API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates a trigger definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateTrigger for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConcurrentModificationException "ConcurrentModificationException"
|
|
// Two processes are trying to modify a resource simultaneously.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateTrigger
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateTrigger(input *UpdateTriggerInput) (*UpdateTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateTriggerWithContext is the same as UpdateTrigger with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateTrigger for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateTriggerWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateTriggerInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateTriggerOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateTriggerRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateUserDefinedFunction = "UpdateUserDefinedFunction"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateUserDefinedFunctionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateUserDefinedFunction operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateUserDefinedFunction for more information on using the UpdateUserDefinedFunction
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateUserDefinedFunctionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateUserDefinedFunctionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateUserDefinedFunction
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateUserDefinedFunction,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateUserDefinedFunctionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateUserDefinedFunction API operation for AWS Glue.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates an existing function definition in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Glue's
|
|
// API operation UpdateUserDefinedFunction for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeEntityNotFoundException "EntityNotFoundException"
|
|
// A specified entity does not exist
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInputException"
|
|
// The input provided was not valid.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServiceException "InternalServiceException"
|
|
// An internal service error occurred.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeOperationTimeoutException "OperationTimeoutException"
|
|
// The operation timed out.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeEncryptionException "GlueEncryptionException"
|
|
// An encryption operation failed.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/glue-2017-03-31/UpdateUserDefinedFunction
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateUserDefinedFunction(input *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) (*UpdateUserDefinedFunctionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateUserDefinedFunctionWithContext is the same as UpdateUserDefinedFunction with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateUserDefinedFunction for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *Glue) UpdateUserDefinedFunctionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateUserDefinedFunctionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateUserDefinedFunctionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Defines an action to be initiated by a trigger.
|
|
type Action struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Arguments to be passed to the job run.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can specify arguments here that your own job-execution script consumes,
|
|
// as well as arguments that AWS Glue itself consumes.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about how to specify and consume your own Job arguments,
|
|
// see the Calling AWS Glue APIs in Python (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-python-calling.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about the key-value pairs that AWS Glue consumes to set up
|
|
// your job, see the Special Parameters Used by AWS Glue (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-etl-glue-arguments.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
Arguments map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of a job to be executed.
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies configuration properties of a job run notification.
|
|
NotificationProperty *NotificationProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used with this action.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The JobRun timeout in minutes. This is the maximum time that a job run can
|
|
// consume resources before it is terminated and enters TIMEOUT status. The
|
|
// default is 2,880 minutes (48 hours). This overrides the timeout value set
|
|
// in the parent job.
|
|
Timeout *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Action) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Action) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Action) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Action"}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SecurityConfiguration != nil && len(*s.SecurityConfiguration) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SecurityConfiguration", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Timeout != nil && *s.Timeout < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Timeout", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NotificationProperty != nil {
|
|
if err := s.NotificationProperty.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("NotificationProperty", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArguments sets the Arguments field's value.
|
|
func (s *Action) SetArguments(v map[string]*string) *Action {
|
|
s.Arguments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Action) SetJobName(v string) *Action {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotificationProperty sets the NotificationProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *Action) SetNotificationProperty(v *NotificationProperty) *Action {
|
|
s.NotificationProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Action) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *Action {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimeout sets the Timeout field's value.
|
|
func (s *Action) SetTimeout(v int64) *Action {
|
|
s.Timeout = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchCreatePartitionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the catalog in which the partion is to be created. Currently, this
|
|
// should be the AWS account ID.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the metadata database in which the partition is to be created.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of PartitionInput structures that define the partitions to be created.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartitionInputList is a required field
|
|
PartitionInputList []*PartitionInput `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the metadata table in which the partition is to be created.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchCreatePartitionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchCreatePartitionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchCreatePartitionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchCreatePartitionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionInputList == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartitionInputList"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionInputList != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.PartitionInputList {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "PartitionInputList", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchCreatePartitionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *BatchCreatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchCreatePartitionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *BatchCreatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionInputList sets the PartitionInputList field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchCreatePartitionInput) SetPartitionInputList(v []*PartitionInput) *BatchCreatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.PartitionInputList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchCreatePartitionInput) SetTableName(v string) *BatchCreatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchCreatePartitionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Errors encountered when trying to create the requested partitions.
|
|
Errors []*PartitionError `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchCreatePartitionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchCreatePartitionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrors sets the Errors field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchCreatePartitionOutput) SetErrors(v []*PartitionError) *BatchCreatePartitionOutput {
|
|
s.Errors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchDeleteConnectionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which the connections reside. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of names of the connections to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// ConnectionNameList is a required field
|
|
ConnectionNameList []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteConnectionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteConnectionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteConnectionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchDeleteConnectionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ConnectionNameList == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ConnectionNameList"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteConnectionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *BatchDeleteConnectionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionNameList sets the ConnectionNameList field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteConnectionInput) SetConnectionNameList(v []*string) *BatchDeleteConnectionInput {
|
|
s.ConnectionNameList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchDeleteConnectionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A map of the names of connections that were not successfully deleted to error
|
|
// details.
|
|
Errors map[string]*ErrorDetail `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of names of the connection definitions that were successfully deleted.
|
|
Succeeded []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteConnectionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteConnectionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrors sets the Errors field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteConnectionOutput) SetErrors(v map[string]*ErrorDetail) *BatchDeleteConnectionOutput {
|
|
s.Errors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSucceeded sets the Succeeded field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteConnectionOutput) SetSucceeded(v []*string) *BatchDeleteConnectionOutput {
|
|
s.Succeeded = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchDeletePartitionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the partition to be deleted resides. If
|
|
// none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database in which the table in question resides.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of PartitionInput structures that define the partitions to be deleted.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartitionsToDelete is a required field
|
|
PartitionsToDelete []*PartitionValueList `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table where the partitions to be deleted is located.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeletePartitionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeletePartitionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeletePartitionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchDeletePartitionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionsToDelete == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartitionsToDelete"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionsToDelete != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.PartitionsToDelete {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "PartitionsToDelete", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeletePartitionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *BatchDeletePartitionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeletePartitionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *BatchDeletePartitionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionsToDelete sets the PartitionsToDelete field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeletePartitionInput) SetPartitionsToDelete(v []*PartitionValueList) *BatchDeletePartitionInput {
|
|
s.PartitionsToDelete = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeletePartitionInput) SetTableName(v string) *BatchDeletePartitionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchDeletePartitionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Errors encountered when trying to delete the requested partitions.
|
|
Errors []*PartitionError `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeletePartitionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeletePartitionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrors sets the Errors field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeletePartitionOutput) SetErrors(v []*PartitionError) *BatchDeletePartitionOutput {
|
|
s.Errors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchDeleteTableInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the table resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the tables to delete reside. For Hive
|
|
// compatibility, this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the table to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// TablesToDelete is a required field
|
|
TablesToDelete []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteTableInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteTableInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchDeleteTableInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TablesToDelete == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TablesToDelete"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *BatchDeleteTableInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *BatchDeleteTableInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTablesToDelete sets the TablesToDelete field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableInput) SetTablesToDelete(v []*string) *BatchDeleteTableInput {
|
|
s.TablesToDelete = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchDeleteTableOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of errors encountered in attempting to delete the specified tables.
|
|
Errors []*TableError `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteTableOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteTableOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrors sets the Errors field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableOutput) SetErrors(v []*TableError) *BatchDeleteTableOutput {
|
|
s.Errors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchDeleteTableVersionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the tables reside. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The database in the catalog in which the table resides. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table. For Hive compatibility, this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the IDs of versions to be deleted.
|
|
//
|
|
// VersionIds is a required field
|
|
VersionIds []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchDeleteTableVersionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.VersionIds == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VersionIds"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) SetTableName(v string) *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionIds sets the VersionIds field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput) SetVersionIds(v []*string) *BatchDeleteTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.VersionIds = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of errors encountered while trying to delete the specified table versions.
|
|
Errors []*TableVersionError `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrors sets the Errors field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput) SetErrors(v []*TableVersionError) *BatchDeleteTableVersionOutput {
|
|
s.Errors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchGetPartitionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the partitions in question reside. If none
|
|
// is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the partitions reside.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of partition values identifying the partitions to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartitionsToGet is a required field
|
|
PartitionsToGet []*PartitionValueList `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the partitions' table.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchGetPartitionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchGetPartitionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchGetPartitionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchGetPartitionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionsToGet == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartitionsToGet"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionsToGet != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.PartitionsToGet {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "PartitionsToGet", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchGetPartitionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *BatchGetPartitionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchGetPartitionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *BatchGetPartitionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionsToGet sets the PartitionsToGet field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchGetPartitionInput) SetPartitionsToGet(v []*PartitionValueList) *BatchGetPartitionInput {
|
|
s.PartitionsToGet = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchGetPartitionInput) SetTableName(v string) *BatchGetPartitionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchGetPartitionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the requested partitions.
|
|
Partitions []*Partition `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the partition values in the request for which partions were not
|
|
// returned.
|
|
UnprocessedKeys []*PartitionValueList `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchGetPartitionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchGetPartitionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitions sets the Partitions field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchGetPartitionOutput) SetPartitions(v []*Partition) *BatchGetPartitionOutput {
|
|
s.Partitions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUnprocessedKeys sets the UnprocessedKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchGetPartitionOutput) SetUnprocessedKeys(v []*PartitionValueList) *BatchGetPartitionOutput {
|
|
s.UnprocessedKeys = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Records an error that occurred when attempting to stop a specified job run.
|
|
type BatchStopJobRunError struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies details about the error that was encountered.
|
|
ErrorDetail *ErrorDetail `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition used in the job run in question.
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The JobRunId of the job run in question.
|
|
JobRunId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchStopJobRunError) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchStopJobRunError) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorDetail sets the ErrorDetail field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunError) SetErrorDetail(v *ErrorDetail) *BatchStopJobRunError {
|
|
s.ErrorDetail = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunError) SetJobName(v string) *BatchStopJobRunError {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobRunId sets the JobRunId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunError) SetJobRunId(v string) *BatchStopJobRunError {
|
|
s.JobRunId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchStopJobRunInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition for which to stop job runs.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobName is a required field
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the JobRunIds that should be stopped for that job definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobRunIds is a required field
|
|
JobRunIds []*string `min:"1" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchStopJobRunInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchStopJobRunInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchStopJobRunInput"}
|
|
if s.JobName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobRunIds == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobRunIds"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobRunIds != nil && len(s.JobRunIds) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobRunIds", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunInput) SetJobName(v string) *BatchStopJobRunInput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobRunIds sets the JobRunIds field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunInput) SetJobRunIds(v []*string) *BatchStopJobRunInput {
|
|
s.JobRunIds = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchStopJobRunOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the errors that were encountered in tryng to stop JobRuns, including
|
|
// the JobRunId for which each error was encountered and details about the error.
|
|
Errors []*BatchStopJobRunError `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the JobRuns that were successfully submitted for stopping.
|
|
SuccessfulSubmissions []*BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchStopJobRunOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchStopJobRunOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrors sets the Errors field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunOutput) SetErrors(v []*BatchStopJobRunError) *BatchStopJobRunOutput {
|
|
s.Errors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSuccessfulSubmissions sets the SuccessfulSubmissions field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunOutput) SetSuccessfulSubmissions(v []*BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission) *BatchStopJobRunOutput {
|
|
s.SuccessfulSubmissions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Records a successful request to stop a specified JobRun.
|
|
type BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition used in the job run that was stopped.
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The JobRunId of the job run that was stopped.
|
|
JobRunId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission) SetJobName(v string) *BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobRunId sets the JobRunId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission) SetJobRunId(v string) *BatchStopJobRunSuccessfulSubmission {
|
|
s.JobRunId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a table definition in the Data Catalog.
|
|
type CatalogEntry struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The database in which the table metadata resides.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table in question.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CatalogEntry) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CatalogEntry) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CatalogEntry) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CatalogEntry"}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CatalogEntry) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CatalogEntry {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CatalogEntry) SetTableName(v string) *CatalogEntry {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A structure containing migration status information.
|
|
type CatalogImportStatus struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// True if the migration has completed, or False otherwise.
|
|
ImportCompleted *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The time that the migration was started.
|
|
ImportTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the person who initiated the migration.
|
|
ImportedBy *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CatalogImportStatus) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CatalogImportStatus) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetImportCompleted sets the ImportCompleted field's value.
|
|
func (s *CatalogImportStatus) SetImportCompleted(v bool) *CatalogImportStatus {
|
|
s.ImportCompleted = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetImportTime sets the ImportTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *CatalogImportStatus) SetImportTime(v time.Time) *CatalogImportStatus {
|
|
s.ImportTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetImportedBy sets the ImportedBy field's value.
|
|
func (s *CatalogImportStatus) SetImportedBy(v string) *CatalogImportStatus {
|
|
s.ImportedBy = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Classifiers are triggered during a crawl task. A classifier checks whether
|
|
// a given file is in a format it can handle, and if it is, the classifier creates
|
|
// a schema in the form of a StructType object that matches that data format.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can use the standard classifiers that AWS Glue supplies, or you can write
|
|
// your own classifiers to best categorize your data sources and specify the
|
|
// appropriate schemas to use for them. A classifier can be a grok classifier,
|
|
// an XML classifier, or a JSON classifier, as specified in one of the fields
|
|
// in the Classifier object.
|
|
type Classifier struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A GrokClassifier object.
|
|
GrokClassifier *GrokClassifier `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A JsonClassifier object.
|
|
JsonClassifier *JsonClassifier `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An XMLClassifier object.
|
|
XMLClassifier *XMLClassifier `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Classifier) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Classifier) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrokClassifier sets the GrokClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *Classifier) SetGrokClassifier(v *GrokClassifier) *Classifier {
|
|
s.GrokClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJsonClassifier sets the JsonClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *Classifier) SetJsonClassifier(v *JsonClassifier) *Classifier {
|
|
s.JsonClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetXMLClassifier sets the XMLClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *Classifier) SetXMLClassifier(v *XMLClassifier) *Classifier {
|
|
s.XMLClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies how CloudWatch data should be encrypted.
|
|
type CloudWatchEncryption struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption mode to use for CloudWatch data.
|
|
CloudWatchEncryptionMode *string `type:"string" enum:"CloudWatchEncryptionMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS ARN of the KMS key to be used to encrypt the data.
|
|
KmsKeyArn *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CloudWatchEncryption) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CloudWatchEncryption) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCloudWatchEncryptionMode sets the CloudWatchEncryptionMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *CloudWatchEncryption) SetCloudWatchEncryptionMode(v string) *CloudWatchEncryption {
|
|
s.CloudWatchEncryptionMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKmsKeyArn sets the KmsKeyArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *CloudWatchEncryption) SetKmsKeyArn(v string) *CloudWatchEncryption {
|
|
s.KmsKeyArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Represents a directional edge in a directed acyclic graph (DAG).
|
|
type CodeGenEdge struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the node at which the edge starts.
|
|
//
|
|
// Source is a required field
|
|
Source *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the node at which the edge ends.
|
|
//
|
|
// Target is a required field
|
|
Target *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The target of the edge.
|
|
TargetParameter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CodeGenEdge) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CodeGenEdge) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenEdge) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CodeGenEdge"}
|
|
if s.Source == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Source"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Source != nil && len(*s.Source) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Source", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Target == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Target"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Target != nil && len(*s.Target) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Target", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenEdge) SetSource(v string) *CodeGenEdge {
|
|
s.Source = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTarget sets the Target field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenEdge) SetTarget(v string) *CodeGenEdge {
|
|
s.Target = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargetParameter sets the TargetParameter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenEdge) SetTargetParameter(v string) *CodeGenEdge {
|
|
s.TargetParameter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Represents a node in a directed acyclic graph (DAG)
|
|
type CodeGenNode struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Properties of the node, in the form of name-value pairs.
|
|
//
|
|
// Args is a required field
|
|
Args []*CodeGenNodeArg `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A node identifier that is unique within the node's graph.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The line number of the node.
|
|
LineNumber *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of node this is.
|
|
//
|
|
// NodeType is a required field
|
|
NodeType *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CodeGenNode) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CodeGenNode) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNode) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CodeGenNode"}
|
|
if s.Args == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Args"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id != nil && len(*s.Id) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Id", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NodeType == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NodeType"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Args != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Args {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Args", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArgs sets the Args field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNode) SetArgs(v []*CodeGenNodeArg) *CodeGenNode {
|
|
s.Args = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNode) SetId(v string) *CodeGenNode {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLineNumber sets the LineNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNode) SetLineNumber(v int64) *CodeGenNode {
|
|
s.LineNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNode) SetNodeType(v string) *CodeGenNode {
|
|
s.NodeType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// An argument or property of a node.
|
|
type CodeGenNodeArg struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the argument or property.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// True if the value is used as a parameter.
|
|
Param *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The value of the argument or property.
|
|
//
|
|
// Value is a required field
|
|
Value *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CodeGenNodeArg) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CodeGenNodeArg) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNodeArg) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CodeGenNodeArg"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Value == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Value"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNodeArg) SetName(v string) *CodeGenNodeArg {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParam sets the Param field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNodeArg) SetParam(v bool) *CodeGenNodeArg {
|
|
s.Param = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
|
|
func (s *CodeGenNodeArg) SetValue(v string) *CodeGenNodeArg {
|
|
s.Value = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A column in a Table.
|
|
type Column struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Free-form text comment.
|
|
Comment *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the Column.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The datatype of data in the Column.
|
|
Type *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Column) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Column) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Column) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Column"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetComment sets the Comment field's value.
|
|
func (s *Column) SetComment(v string) *Column {
|
|
s.Comment = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Column) SetName(v string) *Column {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *Column) SetType(v string) *Column {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Defines a condition under which a trigger fires.
|
|
type Condition struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the Job to whose JobRuns this condition applies and on which
|
|
// this trigger waits.
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A logical operator.
|
|
LogicalOperator *string `type:"string" enum:"LogicalOperator"`
|
|
|
|
// The condition state. Currently, the values supported are SUCCEEDED, STOPPED,
|
|
// TIMEOUT and FAILED.
|
|
State *string `type:"string" enum:"JobRunState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Condition) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Condition) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Condition) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Condition"}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Condition) SetJobName(v string) *Condition {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogicalOperator sets the LogicalOperator field's value.
|
|
func (s *Condition) SetLogicalOperator(v string) *Condition {
|
|
s.LogicalOperator = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *Condition) SetState(v string) *Condition {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Defines a connection to a data source.
|
|
type Connection struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// These key-value pairs define parameters for the connection:
|
|
//
|
|
// * HOST - The host URI: either the fully qualified domain name (FQDN) or
|
|
// the IPv4 address of the database host.
|
|
//
|
|
// * PORT - The port number, between 1024 and 65535, of the port on which
|
|
// the database host is listening for database connections.
|
|
//
|
|
// * USER_NAME - The name under which to log in to the database.
|
|
//
|
|
// * PASSWORD - A password, if one is used, for the user name.
|
|
//
|
|
// * JDBC_DRIVER_JAR_URI - The S3 path of the a jar file that contains the
|
|
// JDBC driver to use.
|
|
//
|
|
// * JDBC_DRIVER_CLASS_NAME - The class name of the JDBC driver to use.
|
|
//
|
|
// * JDBC_ENGINE - The name of the JDBC engine to use.
|
|
//
|
|
// * JDBC_ENGINE_VERSION - The version of the JDBC engine to use.
|
|
//
|
|
// * CONFIG_FILES - (Reserved for future use).
|
|
//
|
|
// * INSTANCE_ID - The instance ID to use.
|
|
//
|
|
// * JDBC_CONNECTION_URL - The URL for the JDBC connection.
|
|
//
|
|
// * JDBC_ENFORCE_SSL - A Boolean string (true, false) specifying whether
|
|
// SSL with hostname matching will be enforced for the JDBC connection on
|
|
// the client. The default is false.
|
|
ConnectionProperties map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of the connection. Currently, only JDBC is supported; SFTP is not
|
|
// supported.
|
|
ConnectionType *string `type:"string" enum:"ConnectionType"`
|
|
|
|
// The time this connection definition was created.
|
|
CreationTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the connection.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The user, group or role that last updated this connection definition.
|
|
LastUpdatedBy *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The last time this connection definition was updated.
|
|
LastUpdatedTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of criteria that can be used in selecting this connection.
|
|
MatchCriteria []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the connection definition.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A map of physical connection requirements, such as VPC and SecurityGroup,
|
|
// needed for making this connection successfully.
|
|
PhysicalConnectionRequirements *PhysicalConnectionRequirements `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Connection) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Connection) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionProperties sets the ConnectionProperties field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetConnectionProperties(v map[string]*string) *Connection {
|
|
s.ConnectionProperties = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionType sets the ConnectionType field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetConnectionType(v string) *Connection {
|
|
s.ConnectionType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreationTime sets the CreationTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetCreationTime(v time.Time) *Connection {
|
|
s.CreationTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetDescription(v string) *Connection {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastUpdatedBy sets the LastUpdatedBy field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetLastUpdatedBy(v string) *Connection {
|
|
s.LastUpdatedBy = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastUpdatedTime sets the LastUpdatedTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetLastUpdatedTime(v time.Time) *Connection {
|
|
s.LastUpdatedTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMatchCriteria sets the MatchCriteria field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetMatchCriteria(v []*string) *Connection {
|
|
s.MatchCriteria = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetName(v string) *Connection {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPhysicalConnectionRequirements sets the PhysicalConnectionRequirements field's value.
|
|
func (s *Connection) SetPhysicalConnectionRequirements(v *PhysicalConnectionRequirements) *Connection {
|
|
s.PhysicalConnectionRequirements = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A structure used to specify a connection to create or update.
|
|
type ConnectionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// These key-value pairs define parameters for the connection.
|
|
//
|
|
// ConnectionProperties is a required field
|
|
ConnectionProperties map[string]*string `type:"map" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of the connection. Currently, only JDBC is supported; SFTP is not
|
|
// supported.
|
|
//
|
|
// ConnectionType is a required field
|
|
ConnectionType *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"ConnectionType"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the connection.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of criteria that can be used in selecting this connection.
|
|
MatchCriteria []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the connection.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A map of physical connection requirements, such as VPC and SecurityGroup,
|
|
// needed for making this connection successfully.
|
|
PhysicalConnectionRequirements *PhysicalConnectionRequirements `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ConnectionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ConnectionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ConnectionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ConnectionInput"}
|
|
if s.ConnectionProperties == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ConnectionProperties"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ConnectionType == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ConnectionType"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PhysicalConnectionRequirements != nil {
|
|
if err := s.PhysicalConnectionRequirements.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("PhysicalConnectionRequirements", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionProperties sets the ConnectionProperties field's value.
|
|
func (s *ConnectionInput) SetConnectionProperties(v map[string]*string) *ConnectionInput {
|
|
s.ConnectionProperties = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionType sets the ConnectionType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ConnectionInput) SetConnectionType(v string) *ConnectionInput {
|
|
s.ConnectionType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *ConnectionInput) SetDescription(v string) *ConnectionInput {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMatchCriteria sets the MatchCriteria field's value.
|
|
func (s *ConnectionInput) SetMatchCriteria(v []*string) *ConnectionInput {
|
|
s.MatchCriteria = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *ConnectionInput) SetName(v string) *ConnectionInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPhysicalConnectionRequirements sets the PhysicalConnectionRequirements field's value.
|
|
func (s *ConnectionInput) SetPhysicalConnectionRequirements(v *PhysicalConnectionRequirements) *ConnectionInput {
|
|
s.PhysicalConnectionRequirements = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the connections used by a job.
|
|
type ConnectionsList struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of connections used by the job.
|
|
Connections []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ConnectionsList) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ConnectionsList) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnections sets the Connections field's value.
|
|
func (s *ConnectionsList) SetConnections(v []*string) *ConnectionsList {
|
|
s.Connections = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a crawler program that examines a data source and uses classifiers
|
|
// to try to determine its schema. If successful, the crawler records metadata
|
|
// concerning the data source in the AWS Glue Data Catalog.
|
|
type Crawler struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of custom classifiers associated with the crawler.
|
|
Classifiers []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Crawler configuration information. This versioned JSON string allows users
|
|
// to specify aspects of a Crawler's behavior.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can use this field to force partitions to inherit metadata such as classification,
|
|
// input format, output format, serde information, and schema from their parent
|
|
// table, rather than detect this information separately for each partition.
|
|
// Use the following JSON string to specify that behavior:
|
|
//
|
|
// Example: '{ "Version": 1.0, "CrawlerOutput": { "Partitions": { "AddOrUpdateBehavior":
|
|
// "InheritFromTable" } } }'
|
|
Configuration *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the crawler is running, contains the total time elapsed since the last
|
|
// crawl began.
|
|
CrawlElapsedTime *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used by this Crawler.
|
|
CrawlerSecurityConfiguration *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The time when the crawler was created.
|
|
CreationTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The database where metadata is written by this crawler.
|
|
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A description of the crawler.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The status of the last crawl, and potentially error information if an error
|
|
// occurred.
|
|
LastCrawl *LastCrawlInfo `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The time the crawler was last updated.
|
|
LastUpdated *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The crawler name.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The IAM role (or ARN of an IAM role) used to access customer resources, such
|
|
// as data in Amazon S3.
|
|
Role *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// For scheduled crawlers, the schedule when the crawler runs.
|
|
Schedule *Schedule `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the behavior when the crawler finds a changed or deleted object.
|
|
SchemaChangePolicy *SchemaChangePolicy `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the crawler is running, or whether a run is pending.
|
|
State *string `type:"string" enum:"CrawlerState"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix added to the names of tables that are created.
|
|
TablePrefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A collection of targets to crawl.
|
|
Targets *CrawlerTargets `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The version of the crawler.
|
|
Version *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Crawler) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Crawler) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassifiers sets the Classifiers field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetClassifiers(v []*string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.Classifiers = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConfiguration sets the Configuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetConfiguration(v string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.Configuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlElapsedTime sets the CrawlElapsedTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetCrawlElapsedTime(v int64) *Crawler {
|
|
s.CrawlElapsedTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerSecurityConfiguration sets the CrawlerSecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetCrawlerSecurityConfiguration(v string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.CrawlerSecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreationTime sets the CreationTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetCreationTime(v time.Time) *Crawler {
|
|
s.CreationTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetDatabaseName(v string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetDescription(v string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastCrawl sets the LastCrawl field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetLastCrawl(v *LastCrawlInfo) *Crawler {
|
|
s.LastCrawl = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastUpdated sets the LastUpdated field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetLastUpdated(v time.Time) *Crawler {
|
|
s.LastUpdated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetName(v string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRole sets the Role field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetRole(v string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.Role = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchedule sets the Schedule field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetSchedule(v *Schedule) *Crawler {
|
|
s.Schedule = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchemaChangePolicy sets the SchemaChangePolicy field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetSchemaChangePolicy(v *SchemaChangePolicy) *Crawler {
|
|
s.SchemaChangePolicy = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetState(v string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTablePrefix sets the TablePrefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetTablePrefix(v string) *Crawler {
|
|
s.TablePrefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargets sets the Targets field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetTargets(v *CrawlerTargets) *Crawler {
|
|
s.Targets = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersion sets the Version field's value.
|
|
func (s *Crawler) SetVersion(v int64) *Crawler {
|
|
s.Version = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Metrics for a specified crawler.
|
|
type CrawlerMetrics struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the crawler.
|
|
CrawlerName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The duration of the crawler's most recent run, in seconds.
|
|
LastRuntimeSeconds *float64 `type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// The median duration of this crawler's runs, in seconds.
|
|
MedianRuntimeSeconds *float64 `type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// True if the crawler is still estimating how long it will take to complete
|
|
// this run.
|
|
StillEstimating *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of tables created by this crawler.
|
|
TablesCreated *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of tables deleted by this crawler.
|
|
TablesDeleted *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of tables updated by this crawler.
|
|
TablesUpdated *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The estimated time left to complete a running crawl.
|
|
TimeLeftSeconds *float64 `type:"double"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CrawlerMetrics) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CrawlerMetrics) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerName sets the CrawlerName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerMetrics) SetCrawlerName(v string) *CrawlerMetrics {
|
|
s.CrawlerName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastRuntimeSeconds sets the LastRuntimeSeconds field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerMetrics) SetLastRuntimeSeconds(v float64) *CrawlerMetrics {
|
|
s.LastRuntimeSeconds = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMedianRuntimeSeconds sets the MedianRuntimeSeconds field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerMetrics) SetMedianRuntimeSeconds(v float64) *CrawlerMetrics {
|
|
s.MedianRuntimeSeconds = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStillEstimating sets the StillEstimating field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerMetrics) SetStillEstimating(v bool) *CrawlerMetrics {
|
|
s.StillEstimating = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTablesCreated sets the TablesCreated field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerMetrics) SetTablesCreated(v int64) *CrawlerMetrics {
|
|
s.TablesCreated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTablesDeleted sets the TablesDeleted field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerMetrics) SetTablesDeleted(v int64) *CrawlerMetrics {
|
|
s.TablesDeleted = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTablesUpdated sets the TablesUpdated field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerMetrics) SetTablesUpdated(v int64) *CrawlerMetrics {
|
|
s.TablesUpdated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimeLeftSeconds sets the TimeLeftSeconds field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerMetrics) SetTimeLeftSeconds(v float64) *CrawlerMetrics {
|
|
s.TimeLeftSeconds = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies data stores to crawl.
|
|
type CrawlerTargets struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies DynamoDB targets.
|
|
DynamoDBTargets []*DynamoDBTarget `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies JDBC targets.
|
|
JdbcTargets []*JdbcTarget `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies Amazon S3 targets.
|
|
S3Targets []*S3Target `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CrawlerTargets) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CrawlerTargets) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDynamoDBTargets sets the DynamoDBTargets field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerTargets) SetDynamoDBTargets(v []*DynamoDBTarget) *CrawlerTargets {
|
|
s.DynamoDBTargets = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJdbcTargets sets the JdbcTargets field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerTargets) SetJdbcTargets(v []*JdbcTarget) *CrawlerTargets {
|
|
s.JdbcTargets = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetS3Targets sets the S3Targets field's value.
|
|
func (s *CrawlerTargets) SetS3Targets(v []*S3Target) *CrawlerTargets {
|
|
s.S3Targets = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateClassifierInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A GrokClassifier object specifying the classifier to create.
|
|
GrokClassifier *CreateGrokClassifierRequest `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A JsonClassifier object specifying the classifier to create.
|
|
JsonClassifier *CreateJsonClassifierRequest `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An XMLClassifier object specifying the classifier to create.
|
|
XMLClassifier *CreateXMLClassifierRequest `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateClassifierInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateClassifierInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateClassifierInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateClassifierInput"}
|
|
if s.GrokClassifier != nil {
|
|
if err := s.GrokClassifier.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("GrokClassifier", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JsonClassifier != nil {
|
|
if err := s.JsonClassifier.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("JsonClassifier", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.XMLClassifier != nil {
|
|
if err := s.XMLClassifier.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("XMLClassifier", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrokClassifier sets the GrokClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateClassifierInput) SetGrokClassifier(v *CreateGrokClassifierRequest) *CreateClassifierInput {
|
|
s.GrokClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJsonClassifier sets the JsonClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateClassifierInput) SetJsonClassifier(v *CreateJsonClassifierRequest) *CreateClassifierInput {
|
|
s.JsonClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetXMLClassifier sets the XMLClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateClassifierInput) SetXMLClassifier(v *CreateXMLClassifierRequest) *CreateClassifierInput {
|
|
s.XMLClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateClassifierOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateClassifierOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateClassifierOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateConnectionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which to create the connection. If none is
|
|
// supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A ConnectionInput object defining the connection to create.
|
|
//
|
|
// ConnectionInput is a required field
|
|
ConnectionInput *ConnectionInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateConnectionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateConnectionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateConnectionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateConnectionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ConnectionInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ConnectionInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ConnectionInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ConnectionInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ConnectionInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateConnectionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *CreateConnectionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionInput sets the ConnectionInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateConnectionInput) SetConnectionInput(v *ConnectionInput) *CreateConnectionInput {
|
|
s.ConnectionInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateConnectionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateConnectionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateConnectionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateCrawlerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of custom classifiers that the user has registered. By default, all
|
|
// built-in classifiers are included in a crawl, but these custom classifiers
|
|
// always override the default classifiers for a given classification.
|
|
Classifiers []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Crawler configuration information. This versioned JSON string allows users
|
|
// to specify aspects of a Crawler's behavior.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can use this field to force partitions to inherit metadata such as classification,
|
|
// input format, output format, serde information, and schema from their parent
|
|
// table, rather than detect this information separately for each partition.
|
|
// Use the following JSON string to specify that behavior:
|
|
//
|
|
// Example: '{ "Version": 1.0, "CrawlerOutput": { "Partitions": { "AddOrUpdateBehavior":
|
|
// "InheritFromTable" } } }'
|
|
Configuration *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used by this Crawler.
|
|
CrawlerSecurityConfiguration *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS Glue database where results are written, such as: arn:aws:daylight:us-east-1::database/sometable/*.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A description of the new crawler.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the new crawler.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The IAM role (or ARN of an IAM role) used by the new crawler to access customer
|
|
// resources.
|
|
//
|
|
// Role is a required field
|
|
Role *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A cron expression used to specify the schedule (see Time-Based Schedules
|
|
// for Jobs and Crawlers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/monitor-data-warehouse-schedule.html).
|
|
// For example, to run something every day at 12:15 UTC, you would specify:
|
|
// cron(15 12 * * ? *).
|
|
Schedule *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Policy for the crawler's update and deletion behavior.
|
|
SchemaChangePolicy *SchemaChangePolicy `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The table prefix used for catalog tables that are created.
|
|
TablePrefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of collection of targets to crawl.
|
|
//
|
|
// Targets is a required field
|
|
Targets *CrawlerTargets `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateCrawlerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateCrawlerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateCrawlerInput"}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Role == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Role"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Targets == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Targets"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassifiers sets the Classifiers field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetClassifiers(v []*string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Classifiers = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConfiguration sets the Configuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetConfiguration(v string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Configuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerSecurityConfiguration sets the CrawlerSecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetCrawlerSecurityConfiguration(v string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.CrawlerSecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetName(v string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRole sets the Role field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetRole(v string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Role = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchedule sets the Schedule field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetSchedule(v string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Schedule = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchemaChangePolicy sets the SchemaChangePolicy field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetSchemaChangePolicy(v *SchemaChangePolicy) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.SchemaChangePolicy = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTablePrefix sets the TablePrefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetTablePrefix(v string) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.TablePrefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargets sets the Targets field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateCrawlerInput) SetTargets(v *CrawlerTargets) *CreateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Targets = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateCrawlerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateCrawlerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateCrawlerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateDatabaseInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which to create the database. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A DatabaseInput object defining the metadata database to create in the catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseInput is a required field
|
|
DatabaseInput *DatabaseInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateDatabaseInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateDatabaseInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateDatabaseInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDatabaseInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DatabaseInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DatabaseInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDatabaseInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *CreateDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseInput sets the DatabaseInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDatabaseInput) SetDatabaseInput(v *DatabaseInput) *CreateDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateDatabaseOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateDatabaseOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateDatabaseOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateDevEndpointInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name to be assigned to the new DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// EndpointName is a required field
|
|
EndpointName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Path to one or more Java Jars in an S3 bucket that should be loaded in your
|
|
// DevEndpoint.
|
|
ExtraJarsS3Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Path(s) to one or more Python libraries in an S3 bucket that should be loaded
|
|
// in your DevEndpoint. Multiple values must be complete paths separated by
|
|
// a comma.
|
|
//
|
|
// Please note that only pure Python libraries can currently be used on a DevEndpoint.
|
|
// Libraries that rely on C extensions, such as the pandas (http://pandas.pydata.org/)
|
|
// Python data analysis library, are not yet supported.
|
|
ExtraPythonLibsS3Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of AWS Glue Data Processing Units (DPUs) to allocate to this DevEndpoint.
|
|
NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The public key to be used by this DevEndpoint for authentication. This attribute
|
|
// is provided for backward compatibility, as the recommended attribute to use
|
|
// is public keys.
|
|
PublicKey *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of public keys to be used by the DevEndpoints for authentication.
|
|
// The use of this attribute is preferred over a single public key because the
|
|
// public keys allow you to have a different private key per client.
|
|
//
|
|
// If you previously created an endpoint with a public key, you must remove
|
|
// that key to be able to set a list of public keys: call the UpdateDevEndpoint
|
|
// API with the public key content in the deletePublicKeys attribute, and the
|
|
// list of new keys in the addPublicKeys attribute.
|
|
PublicKeys []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The IAM role for the DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// RoleArn is a required field
|
|
RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used with this DevEndpoint.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Security group IDs for the security groups to be used by the new DevEndpoint.
|
|
SecurityGroupIds []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The subnet ID for the new DevEndpoint to use.
|
|
SubnetId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateDevEndpointInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateDevEndpointInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDevEndpointInput"}
|
|
if s.EndpointName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EndpointName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RoleArn == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleArn"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SecurityConfiguration != nil && len(*s.SecurityConfiguration) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SecurityConfiguration", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEndpointName sets the EndpointName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetEndpointName(v string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.EndpointName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtraJarsS3Path sets the ExtraJarsS3Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetExtraJarsS3Path(v string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.ExtraJarsS3Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtraPythonLibsS3Path sets the ExtraPythonLibsS3Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetExtraPythonLibsS3Path(v string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.ExtraPythonLibsS3Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.NumberOfNodes = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPublicKey sets the PublicKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetPublicKey(v string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.PublicKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPublicKeys sets the PublicKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetPublicKeys(v []*string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.PublicKeys = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityGroupIds sets the SecurityGroupIds field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.SecurityGroupIds = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSubnetId sets the SubnetId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointInput) SetSubnetId(v string) *CreateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.SubnetId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateDevEndpointOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS availability zone where this DevEndpoint is located.
|
|
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The point in time at which this DevEndpoint was created.
|
|
CreatedTimestamp *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name assigned to the new DevEndpoint.
|
|
EndpointName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Path to one or more Java Jars in an S3 bucket that will be loaded in your
|
|
// DevEndpoint.
|
|
ExtraJarsS3Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Path(s) to one or more Python libraries in an S3 bucket that will be loaded
|
|
// in your DevEndpoint.
|
|
ExtraPythonLibsS3Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The reason for a current failure in this DevEndpoint.
|
|
FailureReason *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of AWS Glue Data Processing Units (DPUs) allocated to this DevEndpoint.
|
|
NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS ARN of the role assigned to the new DevEndpoint.
|
|
RoleArn *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure being used with this DevEndpoint.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The security groups assigned to the new DevEndpoint.
|
|
SecurityGroupIds []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The current status of the new DevEndpoint.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The subnet ID assigned to the new DevEndpoint.
|
|
SubnetId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the VPC used by this DevEndpoint.
|
|
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The address of the YARN endpoint used by this DevEndpoint.
|
|
YarnEndpointAddress *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Apache Zeppelin port for the remote Apache Spark interpreter.
|
|
ZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateDevEndpointOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateDevEndpointOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreatedTimestamp sets the CreatedTimestamp field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetCreatedTimestamp(v time.Time) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.CreatedTimestamp = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEndpointName sets the EndpointName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetEndpointName(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.EndpointName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtraJarsS3Path sets the ExtraJarsS3Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetExtraJarsS3Path(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.ExtraJarsS3Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtraPythonLibsS3Path sets the ExtraPythonLibsS3Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetExtraPythonLibsS3Path(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.ExtraPythonLibsS3Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFailureReason sets the FailureReason field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetFailureReason(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.FailureReason = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.NumberOfNodes = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityGroupIds sets the SecurityGroupIds field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.SecurityGroupIds = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetStatus(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSubnetId sets the SubnetId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetSubnetId(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.SubnetId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetVpcId(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.VpcId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetYarnEndpointAddress sets the YarnEndpointAddress field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetYarnEndpointAddress(v string) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.YarnEndpointAddress = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort sets the ZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateDevEndpointOutput) SetZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort(v int64) *CreateDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.ZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a grok classifier for CreateClassifier to create.
|
|
type CreateGrokClassifierRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An identifier of the data format that the classifier matches, such as Twitter,
|
|
// JSON, Omniture logs, Amazon CloudWatch Logs, and so on.
|
|
//
|
|
// Classification is a required field
|
|
Classification *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Optional custom grok patterns used by this classifier.
|
|
CustomPatterns *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The grok pattern used by this classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// GrokPattern is a required field
|
|
GrokPattern *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the new classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateGrokClassifierRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateGrokClassifierRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateGrokClassifierRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateGrokClassifierRequest"}
|
|
if s.Classification == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Classification"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.GrokPattern == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GrokPattern"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.GrokPattern != nil && len(*s.GrokPattern) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GrokPattern", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassification sets the Classification field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateGrokClassifierRequest) SetClassification(v string) *CreateGrokClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Classification = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCustomPatterns sets the CustomPatterns field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateGrokClassifierRequest) SetCustomPatterns(v string) *CreateGrokClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.CustomPatterns = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrokPattern sets the GrokPattern field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateGrokClassifierRequest) SetGrokPattern(v string) *CreateGrokClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.GrokPattern = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateGrokClassifierRequest) SetName(v string) *CreateGrokClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateJobInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of AWS Glue data processing units (DPUs) to allocate to this Job.
|
|
// From 2 to 100 DPUs can be allocated; the default is 10. A DPU is a relative
|
|
// measure of processing power that consists of 4 vCPUs of compute capacity
|
|
// and 16 GB of memory. For more information, see the AWS Glue pricing page
|
|
// (https://aws.amazon.com/glue/pricing/).
|
|
AllocatedCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The JobCommand that executes this job.
|
|
//
|
|
// Command is a required field
|
|
Command *JobCommand `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The connections used for this job.
|
|
Connections *ConnectionsList `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The default arguments for this job.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can specify arguments here that your own job-execution script consumes,
|
|
// as well as arguments that AWS Glue itself consumes.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about how to specify and consume your own Job arguments,
|
|
// see the Calling AWS Glue APIs in Python (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-python-calling.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about the key-value pairs that AWS Glue consumes to set up
|
|
// your job, see the Special Parameters Used by AWS Glue (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-etl-glue-arguments.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
DefaultArguments map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the job being defined.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// An ExecutionProperty specifying the maximum number of concurrent runs allowed
|
|
// for this job.
|
|
ExecutionProperty *ExecutionProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// This field is reserved for future use.
|
|
LogUri *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of times to retry this job if it fails.
|
|
MaxRetries *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The name you assign to this job definition. It must be unique in your account.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies configuration properties of a job notification.
|
|
NotificationProperty *NotificationProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name or ARN of the IAM role associated with this job.
|
|
//
|
|
// Role is a required field
|
|
Role *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used with this job.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The job timeout in minutes. This is the maximum time that a job run can consume
|
|
// resources before it is terminated and enters TIMEOUT status. The default
|
|
// is 2,880 minutes (48 hours).
|
|
Timeout *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateJobInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateJobInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateJobInput"}
|
|
if s.Command == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Command"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Role == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Role"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SecurityConfiguration != nil && len(*s.SecurityConfiguration) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SecurityConfiguration", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Timeout != nil && *s.Timeout < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Timeout", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NotificationProperty != nil {
|
|
if err := s.NotificationProperty.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("NotificationProperty", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllocatedCapacity sets the AllocatedCapacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetAllocatedCapacity(v int64) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.AllocatedCapacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCommand sets the Command field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetCommand(v *JobCommand) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.Command = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnections sets the Connections field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetConnections(v *ConnectionsList) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.Connections = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDefaultArguments sets the DefaultArguments field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetDefaultArguments(v map[string]*string) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.DefaultArguments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExecutionProperty sets the ExecutionProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetExecutionProperty(v *ExecutionProperty) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.ExecutionProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogUri sets the LogUri field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetLogUri(v string) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.LogUri = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxRetries sets the MaxRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetMaxRetries(v int64) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.MaxRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetName(v string) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotificationProperty sets the NotificationProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetNotificationProperty(v *NotificationProperty) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.NotificationProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRole sets the Role field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetRole(v string) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.Role = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimeout sets the Timeout field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobInput) SetTimeout(v int64) *CreateJobInput {
|
|
s.Timeout = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateJobOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The unique name that was provided for this job definition.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateJobOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateJobOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJobOutput) SetName(v string) *CreateJobOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a JSON classifier for CreateClassifier to create.
|
|
type CreateJsonClassifierRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A JsonPath string defining the JSON data for the classifier to classify.
|
|
// AWS Glue supports a subset of JsonPath, as described in Writing JsonPath
|
|
// Custom Classifiers (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/custom-classifier.html#custom-classifier-json).
|
|
//
|
|
// JsonPath is a required field
|
|
JsonPath *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateJsonClassifierRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateJsonClassifierRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateJsonClassifierRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateJsonClassifierRequest"}
|
|
if s.JsonPath == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JsonPath"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJsonPath sets the JsonPath field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJsonClassifierRequest) SetJsonPath(v string) *CreateJsonClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.JsonPath = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateJsonClassifierRequest) SetName(v string) *CreateJsonClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreatePartitionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the catalog in which the partion is to be created. Currently, this
|
|
// should be the AWS account ID.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the metadata database in which the partition is to be created.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A PartitionInput structure defining the partition to be created.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartitionInput is a required field
|
|
PartitionInput *PartitionInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the metadata table in which the partition is to be created.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreatePartitionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreatePartitionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreatePartitionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreatePartitionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartitionInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.PartitionInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("PartitionInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreatePartitionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *CreatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreatePartitionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CreatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionInput sets the PartitionInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreatePartitionInput) SetPartitionInput(v *PartitionInput) *CreatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.PartitionInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreatePartitionInput) SetTableName(v string) *CreatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreatePartitionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreatePartitionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreatePartitionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateScriptInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the edges in the DAG.
|
|
DagEdges []*CodeGenEdge `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the nodes in the DAG.
|
|
DagNodes []*CodeGenNode `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The programming language of the resulting code from the DAG.
|
|
Language *string `type:"string" enum:"Language"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateScriptInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateScriptInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateScriptInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateScriptInput"}
|
|
if s.DagEdges != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.DagEdges {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "DagEdges", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DagNodes != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.DagNodes {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "DagNodes", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDagEdges sets the DagEdges field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateScriptInput) SetDagEdges(v []*CodeGenEdge) *CreateScriptInput {
|
|
s.DagEdges = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDagNodes sets the DagNodes field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateScriptInput) SetDagNodes(v []*CodeGenNode) *CreateScriptInput {
|
|
s.DagNodes = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguage sets the Language field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateScriptInput) SetLanguage(v string) *CreateScriptInput {
|
|
s.Language = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateScriptOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Python script generated from the DAG.
|
|
PythonScript *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Scala code generated from the DAG.
|
|
ScalaCode *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateScriptOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateScriptOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPythonScript sets the PythonScript field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateScriptOutput) SetPythonScript(v string) *CreateScriptOutput {
|
|
s.PythonScript = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScalaCode sets the ScalaCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateScriptOutput) SetScalaCode(v string) *CreateScriptOutput {
|
|
s.ScalaCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateSecurityConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption configuration for the new security configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// EncryptionConfiguration is a required field
|
|
EncryptionConfiguration *EncryptionConfiguration `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name for the new security configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateSecurityConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateSecurityConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateSecurityConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateSecurityConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.EncryptionConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EncryptionConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncryptionConfiguration sets the EncryptionConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateSecurityConfigurationInput) SetEncryptionConfiguration(v *EncryptionConfiguration) *CreateSecurityConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.EncryptionConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateSecurityConfigurationInput) SetName(v string) *CreateSecurityConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The time at which the new security configuration was created.
|
|
CreatedTimestamp *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name assigned to the new security configuration.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreatedTimestamp sets the CreatedTimestamp field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput) SetCreatedTimestamp(v time.Time) *CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.CreatedTimestamp = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput) SetName(v string) *CreateSecurityConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateTableInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which to create the Table. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The catalog database in which to create the new table. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The TableInput object that defines the metadata table to create in the catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableInput is a required field
|
|
TableInput *TableInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateTableInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateTableInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateTableInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateTableInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.TableInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("TableInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTableInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *CreateTableInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTableInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CreateTableInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableInput sets the TableInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTableInput) SetTableInput(v *TableInput) *CreateTableInput {
|
|
s.TableInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateTableOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateTableOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateTableOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateTriggerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The actions initiated by this trigger when it fires.
|
|
//
|
|
// Actions is a required field
|
|
Actions []*Action `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A description of the new trigger.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A predicate to specify when the new trigger should fire.
|
|
//
|
|
// This field is required when the trigger type is CONDITIONAL.
|
|
Predicate *Predicate `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A cron expression used to specify the schedule (see Time-Based Schedules
|
|
// for Jobs and Crawlers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/monitor-data-warehouse-schedule.html).
|
|
// For example, to run something every day at 12:15 UTC, you would specify:
|
|
// cron(15 12 * * ? *).
|
|
//
|
|
// This field is required when the trigger type is SCHEDULED.
|
|
Schedule *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Set to true to start SCHEDULED and CONDITIONAL triggers when created. True
|
|
// not supported for ON_DEMAND triggers.
|
|
StartOnCreation *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of the new trigger.
|
|
//
|
|
// Type is a required field
|
|
Type *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"TriggerType"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateTriggerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateTriggerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateTriggerInput"}
|
|
if s.Actions == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Actions"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Type == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Type"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Actions != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Actions {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Actions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Predicate != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Predicate.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Predicate", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetActions sets the Actions field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerInput) SetActions(v []*Action) *CreateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Actions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerInput) SetName(v string) *CreateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPredicate sets the Predicate field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerInput) SetPredicate(v *Predicate) *CreateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Predicate = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchedule sets the Schedule field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerInput) SetSchedule(v string) *CreateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Schedule = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStartOnCreation sets the StartOnCreation field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerInput) SetStartOnCreation(v bool) *CreateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.StartOnCreation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerInput) SetType(v string) *CreateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateTriggerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateTriggerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateTriggerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateTriggerOutput) SetName(v string) *CreateTriggerOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which to create the function. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database in which to create the function.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A FunctionInput object that defines the function to create in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// FunctionInput is a required field
|
|
FunctionInput *UserDefinedFunctionInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FunctionInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.FunctionInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("FunctionInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFunctionInput sets the FunctionInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetFunctionInput(v *UserDefinedFunctionInput) *CreateUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.FunctionInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateUserDefinedFunctionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateUserDefinedFunctionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateUserDefinedFunctionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies an XML classifier for CreateClassifier to create.
|
|
type CreateXMLClassifierRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An identifier of the data format that the classifier matches.
|
|
//
|
|
// Classification is a required field
|
|
Classification *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The XML tag designating the element that contains each record in an XML document
|
|
// being parsed. Note that this cannot identify a self-closing element (closed
|
|
// by />). An empty row element that contains only attributes can be parsed
|
|
// as long as it ends with a closing tag (for example, <row item_a="A" item_b="B"></row>
|
|
// is okay, but <row item_a="A" item_b="B" /> is not).
|
|
RowTag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateXMLClassifierRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateXMLClassifierRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateXMLClassifierRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateXMLClassifierRequest"}
|
|
if s.Classification == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Classification"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassification sets the Classification field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateXMLClassifierRequest) SetClassification(v string) *CreateXMLClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Classification = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateXMLClassifierRequest) SetName(v string) *CreateXMLClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRowTag sets the RowTag field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateXMLClassifierRequest) SetRowTag(v string) *CreateXMLClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.RowTag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Contains configuration information for maintaining Data Catalog security.
|
|
type DataCatalogEncryptionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies encryption-at-rest configuration for the Data Catalog.
|
|
EncryptionAtRest *EncryptionAtRest `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DataCatalogEncryptionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DataCatalogEncryptionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DataCatalogEncryptionSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DataCatalogEncryptionSettings"}
|
|
if s.EncryptionAtRest != nil {
|
|
if err := s.EncryptionAtRest.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("EncryptionAtRest", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncryptionAtRest sets the EncryptionAtRest field's value.
|
|
func (s *DataCatalogEncryptionSettings) SetEncryptionAtRest(v *EncryptionAtRest) *DataCatalogEncryptionSettings {
|
|
s.EncryptionAtRest = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The Database object represents a logical grouping of tables that may reside
|
|
// in a Hive metastore or an RDBMS.
|
|
type Database struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The time at which the metadata database was created in the catalog.
|
|
CreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the database.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The location of the database (for example, an HDFS path).
|
|
LocationUri *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the database. For Hive compatibility, this is folded to lowercase
|
|
// when it is stored.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// These key-value pairs define parameters and properties of the database.
|
|
Parameters map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Database) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Database) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreateTime sets the CreateTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Database) SetCreateTime(v time.Time) *Database {
|
|
s.CreateTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *Database) SetDescription(v string) *Database {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocationUri sets the LocationUri field's value.
|
|
func (s *Database) SetLocationUri(v string) *Database {
|
|
s.LocationUri = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Database) SetName(v string) *Database {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *Database) SetParameters(v map[string]*string) *Database {
|
|
s.Parameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The structure used to create or update a database.
|
|
type DatabaseInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the database
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The location of the database (for example, an HDFS path).
|
|
LocationUri *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the database. For Hive compatibility, this is folded to lowercase
|
|
// when it is stored.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Thes key-value pairs define parameters and properties of the database.
|
|
Parameters map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DatabaseInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DatabaseInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DatabaseInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DatabaseInput"}
|
|
if s.LocationUri != nil && len(*s.LocationUri) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("LocationUri", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *DatabaseInput) SetDescription(v string) *DatabaseInput {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocationUri sets the LocationUri field's value.
|
|
func (s *DatabaseInput) SetLocationUri(v string) *DatabaseInput {
|
|
s.LocationUri = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DatabaseInput) SetName(v string) *DatabaseInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *DatabaseInput) SetParameters(v map[string]*string) *DatabaseInput {
|
|
s.Parameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteClassifierInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the classifier to remove.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteClassifierInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteClassifierInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteClassifierInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteClassifierInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteClassifierInput) SetName(v string) *DeleteClassifierInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteClassifierOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteClassifierOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteClassifierOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteConnectionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which the connection resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the connection to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// ConnectionName is a required field
|
|
ConnectionName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteConnectionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteConnectionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteConnectionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteConnectionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ConnectionName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ConnectionName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ConnectionName != nil && len(*s.ConnectionName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ConnectionName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteConnectionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *DeleteConnectionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionName sets the ConnectionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteConnectionInput) SetConnectionName(v string) *DeleteConnectionInput {
|
|
s.ConnectionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteConnectionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteConnectionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteConnectionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteCrawlerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the crawler to remove.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteCrawlerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteCrawlerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteCrawlerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteCrawlerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteCrawlerInput) SetName(v string) *DeleteCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteCrawlerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteCrawlerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteCrawlerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteDatabaseInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which the database resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the Database to delete. For Hive compatibility, this must be
|
|
// all lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteDatabaseInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteDatabaseInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteDatabaseInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDatabaseInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteDatabaseInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *DeleteDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteDatabaseInput) SetName(v string) *DeleteDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteDatabaseOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteDatabaseOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteDatabaseOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteDevEndpointInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// EndpointName is a required field
|
|
EndpointName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteDevEndpointInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteDevEndpointInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteDevEndpointInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDevEndpointInput"}
|
|
if s.EndpointName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EndpointName"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEndpointName sets the EndpointName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteDevEndpointInput) SetEndpointName(v string) *DeleteDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.EndpointName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteDevEndpointOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteDevEndpointOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteDevEndpointOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteJobInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobName is a required field
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteJobInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteJobInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteJobInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteJobInput"}
|
|
if s.JobName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteJobInput) SetJobName(v string) *DeleteJobInput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteJobOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition that was deleted.
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteJobOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteJobOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteJobOutput) SetJobName(v string) *DeleteJobOutput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeletePartitionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the partition to be deleted resides. If
|
|
// none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database in which the table in question resides.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The values that define the partition.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartitionValues is a required field
|
|
PartitionValues []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table where the partition to be deleted is located.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletePartitionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletePartitionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeletePartitionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeletePartitionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionValues == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartitionValues"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletePartitionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *DeletePartitionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletePartitionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *DeletePartitionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionValues sets the PartitionValues field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletePartitionInput) SetPartitionValues(v []*string) *DeletePartitionInput {
|
|
s.PartitionValues = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletePartitionInput) SetTableName(v string) *DeletePartitionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeletePartitionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletePartitionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletePartitionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the security configuration to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput) SetName(v string) *DeleteSecurityConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteSecurityConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteSecurityConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteSecurityConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteTableInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the table resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database in which the table resides. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table to be deleted. For Hive compatibility, this name is
|
|
// entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTableInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTableInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteTableInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *DeleteTableInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *DeleteTableInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableInput) SetName(v string) *DeleteTableInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteTableOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTableOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTableOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteTableVersionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the tables reside. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The database in the catalog in which the table resides. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table. For Hive compatibility, this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the table version to be deleted.
|
|
//
|
|
// VersionId is a required field
|
|
VersionId *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTableVersionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTableVersionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableVersionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteTableVersionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.VersionId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VersionId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.VersionId != nil && len(*s.VersionId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("VersionId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableVersionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *DeleteTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableVersionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *DeleteTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableVersionInput) SetTableName(v string) *DeleteTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTableVersionInput) SetVersionId(v string) *DeleteTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteTableVersionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTableVersionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTableVersionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteTriggerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTriggerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTriggerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTriggerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteTriggerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTriggerInput) SetName(v string) *DeleteTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteTriggerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger that was deleted.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTriggerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteTriggerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteTriggerOutput) SetName(v string) *DeleteTriggerOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the function to be deleted is located. If
|
|
// none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the function is located.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the function definition to be deleted.
|
|
//
|
|
// FunctionName is a required field
|
|
FunctionName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FunctionName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionName != nil && len(*s.FunctionName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("FunctionName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFunctionName sets the FunctionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetFunctionName(v string) *DeleteUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.FunctionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteUserDefinedFunctionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteUserDefinedFunctionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteUserDefinedFunctionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A development endpoint where a developer can remotely debug ETL scripts.
|
|
type DevEndpoint struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS availability zone where this DevEndpoint is located.
|
|
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The point in time at which this DevEndpoint was created.
|
|
CreatedTimestamp *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the DevEndpoint.
|
|
EndpointName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Path to one or more Java Jars in an S3 bucket that should be loaded in your
|
|
// DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// Please note that only pure Java/Scala libraries can currently be used on
|
|
// a DevEndpoint.
|
|
ExtraJarsS3Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Path(s) to one or more Python libraries in an S3 bucket that should be loaded
|
|
// in your DevEndpoint. Multiple values must be complete paths separated by
|
|
// a comma.
|
|
//
|
|
// Please note that only pure Python libraries can currently be used on a DevEndpoint.
|
|
// Libraries that rely on C extensions, such as the pandas (http://pandas.pydata.org/)
|
|
// Python data analysis library, are not yet supported.
|
|
ExtraPythonLibsS3Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The reason for a current failure in this DevEndpoint.
|
|
FailureReason *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The point in time at which this DevEndpoint was last modified.
|
|
LastModifiedTimestamp *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The status of the last update.
|
|
LastUpdateStatus *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of AWS Glue Data Processing Units (DPUs) allocated to this DevEndpoint.
|
|
NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A private DNS to access the DevEndpoint within a VPC, if the DevEndpoint
|
|
// is created within one.
|
|
PrivateAddress *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The public VPC address used by this DevEndpoint.
|
|
PublicAddress *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The public key to be used by this DevEndpoint for authentication. This attribute
|
|
// is provided for backward compatibility, as the recommended attribute to use
|
|
// is public keys.
|
|
PublicKey *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of public keys to be used by the DevEndpoints for authentication.
|
|
// The use of this attribute is preferred over a single public key because the
|
|
// public keys allow you to have a different private key per client.
|
|
//
|
|
// If you previously created an endpoint with a public key, you must remove
|
|
// that key to be able to set a list of public keys: call the UpdateDevEndpoint
|
|
// API with the public key content in the deletePublicKeys attribute, and the
|
|
// list of new keys in the addPublicKeys attribute.
|
|
PublicKeys []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS ARN of the IAM role used in this DevEndpoint.
|
|
RoleArn *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used with this DevEndpoint.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of security group identifiers used in this DevEndpoint.
|
|
SecurityGroupIds []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The current status of this DevEndpoint.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The subnet ID for this DevEndpoint.
|
|
SubnetId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the virtual private cloud (VPC) used by this DevEndpoint.
|
|
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The YARN endpoint address used by this DevEndpoint.
|
|
YarnEndpointAddress *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Apache Zeppelin port for the remote Apache Spark interpreter.
|
|
ZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DevEndpoint) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DevEndpoint) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreatedTimestamp sets the CreatedTimestamp field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetCreatedTimestamp(v time.Time) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.CreatedTimestamp = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEndpointName sets the EndpointName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetEndpointName(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.EndpointName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtraJarsS3Path sets the ExtraJarsS3Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetExtraJarsS3Path(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.ExtraJarsS3Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtraPythonLibsS3Path sets the ExtraPythonLibsS3Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetExtraPythonLibsS3Path(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.ExtraPythonLibsS3Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFailureReason sets the FailureReason field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetFailureReason(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.FailureReason = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModifiedTimestamp sets the LastModifiedTimestamp field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetLastModifiedTimestamp(v time.Time) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.LastModifiedTimestamp = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastUpdateStatus sets the LastUpdateStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetLastUpdateStatus(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.LastUpdateStatus = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.NumberOfNodes = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrivateAddress sets the PrivateAddress field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetPrivateAddress(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.PrivateAddress = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPublicAddress sets the PublicAddress field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetPublicAddress(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.PublicAddress = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPublicKey sets the PublicKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetPublicKey(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.PublicKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPublicKeys sets the PublicKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetPublicKeys(v []*string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.PublicKeys = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetRoleArn(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityGroupIds sets the SecurityGroupIds field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.SecurityGroupIds = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetStatus(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSubnetId sets the SubnetId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetSubnetId(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.SubnetId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetVpcId(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.VpcId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetYarnEndpointAddress sets the YarnEndpointAddress field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetYarnEndpointAddress(v string) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.YarnEndpointAddress = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort sets the ZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpoint) SetZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort(v int64) *DevEndpoint {
|
|
s.ZeppelinRemoteSparkInterpreterPort = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Custom libraries to be loaded into a DevEndpoint.
|
|
type DevEndpointCustomLibraries struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Path to one or more Java Jars in an S3 bucket that should be loaded in your
|
|
// DevEndpoint.
|
|
//
|
|
// Please note that only pure Java/Scala libraries can currently be used on
|
|
// a DevEndpoint.
|
|
ExtraJarsS3Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Path(s) to one or more Python libraries in an S3 bucket that should be loaded
|
|
// in your DevEndpoint. Multiple values must be complete paths separated by
|
|
// a comma.
|
|
//
|
|
// Please note that only pure Python libraries can currently be used on a DevEndpoint.
|
|
// Libraries that rely on C extensions, such as the pandas (http://pandas.pydata.org/)
|
|
// Python data analysis library, are not yet supported.
|
|
ExtraPythonLibsS3Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DevEndpointCustomLibraries) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DevEndpointCustomLibraries) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtraJarsS3Path sets the ExtraJarsS3Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpointCustomLibraries) SetExtraJarsS3Path(v string) *DevEndpointCustomLibraries {
|
|
s.ExtraJarsS3Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtraPythonLibsS3Path sets the ExtraPythonLibsS3Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *DevEndpointCustomLibraries) SetExtraPythonLibsS3Path(v string) *DevEndpointCustomLibraries {
|
|
s.ExtraPythonLibsS3Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a DynamoDB table to crawl.
|
|
type DynamoDBTarget struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the DynamoDB table to crawl.
|
|
Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DynamoDBTarget) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DynamoDBTarget) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPath sets the Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *DynamoDBTarget) SetPath(v string) *DynamoDBTarget {
|
|
s.Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies encryption-at-rest configuration for the Data Catalog.
|
|
type EncryptionAtRest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption-at-rest mode for encrypting Data Catalog data.
|
|
//
|
|
// CatalogEncryptionMode is a required field
|
|
CatalogEncryptionMode *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"CatalogEncryptionMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the AWS KMS key to use for encryption at rest.
|
|
SseAwsKmsKeyId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EncryptionAtRest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EncryptionAtRest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *EncryptionAtRest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "EncryptionAtRest"}
|
|
if s.CatalogEncryptionMode == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CatalogEncryptionMode"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SseAwsKmsKeyId != nil && len(*s.SseAwsKmsKeyId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SseAwsKmsKeyId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogEncryptionMode sets the CatalogEncryptionMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncryptionAtRest) SetCatalogEncryptionMode(v string) *EncryptionAtRest {
|
|
s.CatalogEncryptionMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSseAwsKmsKeyId sets the SseAwsKmsKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncryptionAtRest) SetSseAwsKmsKeyId(v string) *EncryptionAtRest {
|
|
s.SseAwsKmsKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies an encryption configuration.
|
|
type EncryptionConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption configuration for CloudWatch.
|
|
CloudWatchEncryption *CloudWatchEncryption `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption configuration for Job Bookmarks.
|
|
JobBookmarksEncryption *JobBookmarksEncryption `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption configuration for S3 data.
|
|
S3Encryption []*S3Encryption `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EncryptionConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EncryptionConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCloudWatchEncryption sets the CloudWatchEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncryptionConfiguration) SetCloudWatchEncryption(v *CloudWatchEncryption) *EncryptionConfiguration {
|
|
s.CloudWatchEncryption = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobBookmarksEncryption sets the JobBookmarksEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncryptionConfiguration) SetJobBookmarksEncryption(v *JobBookmarksEncryption) *EncryptionConfiguration {
|
|
s.JobBookmarksEncryption = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetS3Encryption sets the S3Encryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncryptionConfiguration) SetS3Encryption(v []*S3Encryption) *EncryptionConfiguration {
|
|
s.S3Encryption = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Contains details about an error.
|
|
type ErrorDetail struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The code associated with this error.
|
|
ErrorCode *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A message describing the error.
|
|
ErrorMessage *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ErrorDetail) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ErrorDetail) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorCode sets the ErrorCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *ErrorDetail) SetErrorCode(v string) *ErrorDetail {
|
|
s.ErrorCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorMessage sets the ErrorMessage field's value.
|
|
func (s *ErrorDetail) SetErrorMessage(v string) *ErrorDetail {
|
|
s.ErrorMessage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// An execution property of a job.
|
|
type ExecutionProperty struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of concurrent runs allowed for the job. The default is
|
|
// 1. An error is returned when this threshold is reached. The maximum value
|
|
// you can specify is controlled by a service limit.
|
|
MaxConcurrentRuns *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ExecutionProperty) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ExecutionProperty) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxConcurrentRuns sets the MaxConcurrentRuns field's value.
|
|
func (s *ExecutionProperty) SetMaxConcurrentRuns(v int64) *ExecutionProperty {
|
|
s.MaxConcurrentRuns = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetCatalogImportStatusInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the catalog to migrate. Currently, this should be the AWS account
|
|
// ID.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCatalogImportStatusInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCatalogImportStatusInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetCatalogImportStatusInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetCatalogImportStatusInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCatalogImportStatusInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetCatalogImportStatusInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetCatalogImportStatusOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The status of the specified catalog migration.
|
|
ImportStatus *CatalogImportStatus `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCatalogImportStatusOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCatalogImportStatusOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetImportStatus sets the ImportStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCatalogImportStatusOutput) SetImportStatus(v *CatalogImportStatus) *GetCatalogImportStatusOutput {
|
|
s.ImportStatus = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetClassifierInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the classifier to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetClassifierInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetClassifierInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetClassifierInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetClassifierInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetClassifierInput) SetName(v string) *GetClassifierInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetClassifierOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested classifier.
|
|
Classifier *Classifier `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetClassifierOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetClassifierOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassifier sets the Classifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetClassifierOutput) SetClassifier(v *Classifier) *GetClassifierOutput {
|
|
s.Classifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetClassifiersInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Size of the list to return (optional).
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// An optional continuation token.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetClassifiersInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetClassifiersInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetClassifiersInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetClassifiersInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetClassifiersInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetClassifiersInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetClassifiersInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetClassifiersInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetClassifiersOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested list of classifier objects.
|
|
Classifiers []*Classifier `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetClassifiersOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetClassifiersOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassifiers sets the Classifiers field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetClassifiersOutput) SetClassifiers(v []*Classifier) *GetClassifiersOutput {
|
|
s.Classifiers = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetClassifiersOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetClassifiersOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetConnectionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which the connection resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the connection definition to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetConnectionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetConnectionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionInput) SetName(v string) *GetConnectionInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetConnectionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested connection definition.
|
|
Connection *Connection `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnection sets the Connection field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionOutput) SetConnection(v *Connection) *GetConnectionOutput {
|
|
s.Connection = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Filters the connection definitions returned by the GetConnections API.
|
|
type GetConnectionsFilter struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of connections to return. Currently, only JDBC is supported; SFTP
|
|
// is not supported.
|
|
ConnectionType *string `type:"string" enum:"ConnectionType"`
|
|
|
|
// A criteria string that must match the criteria recorded in the connection
|
|
// definition for that connection definition to be returned.
|
|
MatchCriteria []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionsFilter) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionsFilter) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionType sets the ConnectionType field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsFilter) SetConnectionType(v string) *GetConnectionsFilter {
|
|
s.ConnectionType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMatchCriteria sets the MatchCriteria field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsFilter) SetMatchCriteria(v []*string) *GetConnectionsFilter {
|
|
s.MatchCriteria = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetConnectionsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which the connections reside. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A filter that controls which connections will be returned.
|
|
Filter *GetConnectionsFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of connections to return in one response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetConnectionsInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetConnectionsInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsInput) SetFilter(v *GetConnectionsFilter) *GetConnectionsInput {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetConnectionsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetConnectionsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetConnectionsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of requested connection definitions.
|
|
ConnectionList []*Connection `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if the list of connections returned does not include
|
|
// the last of the filtered connections.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetConnectionsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionList sets the ConnectionList field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsOutput) SetConnectionList(v []*Connection) *GetConnectionsOutput {
|
|
s.ConnectionList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetConnectionsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetConnectionsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetCrawlerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the crawler to retrieve metadata for.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetCrawlerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerInput) SetName(v string) *GetCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetCrawlerMetricsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the names of crawlers about which to retrieve metrics.
|
|
CrawlerNameList []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum size of a list to return.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlerMetricsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlerMetricsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerMetricsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetCrawlerMetricsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerNameList sets the CrawlerNameList field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerMetricsInput) SetCrawlerNameList(v []*string) *GetCrawlerMetricsInput {
|
|
s.CrawlerNameList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerMetricsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetCrawlerMetricsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerMetricsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetCrawlerMetricsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetCrawlerMetricsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of metrics for the specified crawler.
|
|
CrawlerMetricsList []*CrawlerMetrics `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if the returned list does not contain the last metric
|
|
// available.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlerMetricsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlerMetricsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerMetricsList sets the CrawlerMetricsList field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerMetricsOutput) SetCrawlerMetricsList(v []*CrawlerMetrics) *GetCrawlerMetricsOutput {
|
|
s.CrawlerMetricsList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerMetricsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetCrawlerMetricsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetCrawlerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The metadata for the specified crawler.
|
|
Crawler *Crawler `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawler sets the Crawler field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlerOutput) SetCrawler(v *Crawler) *GetCrawlerOutput {
|
|
s.Crawler = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetCrawlersInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of crawlers to return on each call.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation request.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlersInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlersInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlersInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetCrawlersInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlersInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetCrawlersInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlersInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetCrawlersInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetCrawlersOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of crawler metadata.
|
|
Crawlers []*Crawler `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if the returned list has not reached the end of those
|
|
// defined in this customer account.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlersOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetCrawlersOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlers sets the Crawlers field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlersOutput) SetCrawlers(v []*Crawler) *GetCrawlersOutput {
|
|
s.Crawlers = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetCrawlersOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetCrawlersOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog for which to retrieve the security configuration.
|
|
// If none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested security configuration.
|
|
DataCatalogEncryptionSettings *DataCatalogEncryptionSettings `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings sets the DataCatalogEncryptionSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput) SetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings(v *DataCatalogEncryptionSettings) *GetDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput {
|
|
s.DataCatalogEncryptionSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDatabaseInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which the database resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the database to retrieve. For Hive compatibility, this should
|
|
// be all lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDatabaseInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDatabaseInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabaseInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetDatabaseInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabaseInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabaseInput) SetName(v string) *GetDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDatabaseOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The definition of the specified database in the catalog.
|
|
Database *Database `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDatabaseOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDatabaseOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabase sets the Database field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabaseOutput) SetDatabase(v *Database) *GetDatabaseOutput {
|
|
s.Database = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDatabasesInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog from which to retrieve Databases. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of databases to return in one response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDatabasesInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDatabasesInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabasesInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetDatabasesInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabasesInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetDatabasesInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabasesInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetDatabasesInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabasesInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetDatabasesInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDatabasesOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of Database objects from the specified catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseList is a required field
|
|
DatabaseList []*Database `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token for paginating the returned list of tokens, returned
|
|
// if the current segment of the list is not the last.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDatabasesOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDatabasesOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseList sets the DatabaseList field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabasesOutput) SetDatabaseList(v []*Database) *GetDatabasesOutput {
|
|
s.DatabaseList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDatabasesOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetDatabasesOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDataflowGraphInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Python script to transform.
|
|
PythonScript *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDataflowGraphInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDataflowGraphInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPythonScript sets the PythonScript field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDataflowGraphInput) SetPythonScript(v string) *GetDataflowGraphInput {
|
|
s.PythonScript = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDataflowGraphOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the edges in the resulting DAG.
|
|
DagEdges []*CodeGenEdge `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the nodes in the resulting DAG.
|
|
DagNodes []*CodeGenNode `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDataflowGraphOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDataflowGraphOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDagEdges sets the DagEdges field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDataflowGraphOutput) SetDagEdges(v []*CodeGenEdge) *GetDataflowGraphOutput {
|
|
s.DagEdges = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDagNodes sets the DagNodes field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDataflowGraphOutput) SetDagNodes(v []*CodeGenNode) *GetDataflowGraphOutput {
|
|
s.DagNodes = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDevEndpointInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the DevEndpoint for which to retrieve information.
|
|
//
|
|
// EndpointName is a required field
|
|
EndpointName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDevEndpointInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDevEndpointInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetDevEndpointInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetDevEndpointInput"}
|
|
if s.EndpointName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EndpointName"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEndpointName sets the EndpointName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDevEndpointInput) SetEndpointName(v string) *GetDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.EndpointName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDevEndpointOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A DevEndpoint definition.
|
|
DevEndpoint *DevEndpoint `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDevEndpointOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDevEndpointOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDevEndpoint sets the DevEndpoint field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDevEndpointOutput) SetDevEndpoint(v *DevEndpoint) *GetDevEndpointOutput {
|
|
s.DevEndpoint = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDevEndpointsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum size of information to return.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDevEndpointsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDevEndpointsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetDevEndpointsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetDevEndpointsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDevEndpointsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetDevEndpointsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDevEndpointsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetDevEndpointsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetDevEndpointsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of DevEndpoint definitions.
|
|
DevEndpoints []*DevEndpoint `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if not all DevEndpoint definitions have yet been returned.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDevEndpointsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetDevEndpointsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDevEndpoints sets the DevEndpoints field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDevEndpointsOutput) SetDevEndpoints(v []*DevEndpoint) *GetDevEndpointsOutput {
|
|
s.DevEndpoints = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetDevEndpointsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetDevEndpointsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetJobInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobName is a required field
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetJobInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetJobInput"}
|
|
if s.JobName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobInput) SetJobName(v string) *GetJobInput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetJobOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested job definition.
|
|
Job *Job `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJob sets the Job field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobOutput) SetJob(v *Job) *GetJobOutput {
|
|
s.Job = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetJobRunInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the job definition being run.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobName is a required field
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// True if a list of predecessor runs should be returned.
|
|
PredecessorsIncluded *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the job run.
|
|
//
|
|
// RunId is a required field
|
|
RunId *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobRunInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobRunInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetJobRunInput"}
|
|
if s.JobName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RunId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RunId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RunId != nil && len(*s.RunId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RunId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunInput) SetJobName(v string) *GetJobRunInput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPredecessorsIncluded sets the PredecessorsIncluded field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunInput) SetPredecessorsIncluded(v bool) *GetJobRunInput {
|
|
s.PredecessorsIncluded = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRunId sets the RunId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunInput) SetRunId(v string) *GetJobRunInput {
|
|
s.RunId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetJobRunOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested job-run metadata.
|
|
JobRun *JobRun `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobRunOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobRunOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobRun sets the JobRun field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunOutput) SetJobRun(v *JobRun) *GetJobRunOutput {
|
|
s.JobRun = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetJobRunsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition for which to retrieve all job runs.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobName is a required field
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum size of the response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobRunsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobRunsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetJobRunsInput"}
|
|
if s.JobName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunsInput) SetJobName(v string) *GetJobRunsInput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetJobRunsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetJobRunsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetJobRunsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of job-run metatdata objects.
|
|
JobRuns []*JobRun `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if not all reequested job runs have been returned.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobRunsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobRunsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobRuns sets the JobRuns field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunsOutput) SetJobRuns(v []*JobRun) *GetJobRunsOutput {
|
|
s.JobRuns = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobRunsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetJobRunsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetJobsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum size of the response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetJobsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetJobsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetJobsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetJobsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetJobsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of job definitions.
|
|
Jobs []*Job `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if not all job definitions have yet been returned.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetJobsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobs sets the Jobs field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobsOutput) SetJobs(v []*Job) *GetJobsOutput {
|
|
s.Jobs = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetJobsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetJobsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetMappingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Parameters for the mapping.
|
|
Location *Location `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of target tables.
|
|
Sinks []*CatalogEntry `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the source table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Source is a required field
|
|
Source *CatalogEntry `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetMappingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetMappingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetMappingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetMappingInput"}
|
|
if s.Source == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Source"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Location != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Location.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Location", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Sinks != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Sinks {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Sinks", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Source != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Source.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Source", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocation sets the Location field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetMappingInput) SetLocation(v *Location) *GetMappingInput {
|
|
s.Location = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSinks sets the Sinks field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetMappingInput) SetSinks(v []*CatalogEntry) *GetMappingInput {
|
|
s.Sinks = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetMappingInput) SetSource(v *CatalogEntry) *GetMappingInput {
|
|
s.Source = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetMappingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of mappings to the specified targets.
|
|
//
|
|
// Mapping is a required field
|
|
Mapping []*MappingEntry `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetMappingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetMappingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMapping sets the Mapping field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetMappingOutput) SetMapping(v []*MappingEntry) *GetMappingOutput {
|
|
s.Mapping = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetPartitionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the partition in question resides. If none
|
|
// is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the partition resides.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The values that define the partition.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartitionValues is a required field
|
|
PartitionValues []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the partition's table.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPartitionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPartitionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetPartitionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionValues == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartitionValues"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetPartitionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GetPartitionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionValues sets the PartitionValues field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionInput) SetPartitionValues(v []*string) *GetPartitionInput {
|
|
s.PartitionValues = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionInput) SetTableName(v string) *GetPartitionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetPartitionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested information, in the form of a Partition object.
|
|
Partition *Partition `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPartitionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPartitionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartition sets the Partition field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionOutput) SetPartition(v *Partition) *GetPartitionOutput {
|
|
s.Partition = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetPartitionsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the partitions in question reside. If none
|
|
// is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the partitions reside.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// An expression filtering the partitions to be returned.
|
|
Expression *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of partitions to return in a single response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is not the first call to retrieve these partitions.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The segment of the table's partitions to scan in this request.
|
|
Segment *Segment `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the partitions' table.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPartitionsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPartitionsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetPartitionsInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Segment != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Segment.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Segment", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetPartitionsInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GetPartitionsInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpression sets the Expression field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsInput) SetExpression(v string) *GetPartitionsInput {
|
|
s.Expression = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetPartitionsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetPartitionsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegment sets the Segment field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsInput) SetSegment(v *Segment) *GetPartitionsInput {
|
|
s.Segment = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsInput) SetTableName(v string) *GetPartitionsInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetPartitionsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if the returned list of partitions does not does not
|
|
// include the last one.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of requested partitions.
|
|
Partitions []*Partition `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPartitionsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPartitionsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetPartitionsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitions sets the Partitions field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPartitionsOutput) SetPartitions(v []*Partition) *GetPartitionsOutput {
|
|
s.Partitions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetPlanInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The programming language of the code to perform the mapping.
|
|
Language *string `type:"string" enum:"Language"`
|
|
|
|
// Parameters for the mapping.
|
|
Location *Location `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of mappings from a source table to target tables.
|
|
//
|
|
// Mapping is a required field
|
|
Mapping []*MappingEntry `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The target tables.
|
|
Sinks []*CatalogEntry `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The source table.
|
|
//
|
|
// Source is a required field
|
|
Source *CatalogEntry `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPlanInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPlanInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetPlanInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetPlanInput"}
|
|
if s.Mapping == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Mapping"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Source == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Source"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Location != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Location.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Location", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Sinks != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Sinks {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Sinks", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Source != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Source.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Source", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguage sets the Language field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPlanInput) SetLanguage(v string) *GetPlanInput {
|
|
s.Language = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocation sets the Location field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPlanInput) SetLocation(v *Location) *GetPlanInput {
|
|
s.Location = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMapping sets the Mapping field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPlanInput) SetMapping(v []*MappingEntry) *GetPlanInput {
|
|
s.Mapping = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSinks sets the Sinks field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPlanInput) SetSinks(v []*CatalogEntry) *GetPlanInput {
|
|
s.Sinks = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPlanInput) SetSource(v *CatalogEntry) *GetPlanInput {
|
|
s.Source = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetPlanOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A Python script to perform the mapping.
|
|
PythonScript *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Scala code to perform the mapping.
|
|
ScalaCode *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPlanOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPlanOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPythonScript sets the PythonScript field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPlanOutput) SetPythonScript(v string) *GetPlanOutput {
|
|
s.PythonScript = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScalaCode sets the ScalaCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPlanOutput) SetScalaCode(v string) *GetPlanOutput {
|
|
s.ScalaCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetSecurityConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the security configuration to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetSecurityConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetSecurityConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetSecurityConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetSecurityConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetSecurityConfigurationInput) SetName(v string) *GetSecurityConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetSecurityConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested security configuration
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *SecurityConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetSecurityConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetSecurityConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetSecurityConfigurationOutput) SetSecurityConfiguration(v *SecurityConfiguration) *GetSecurityConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetSecurityConfigurationsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of results to return.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetSecurityConfigurationsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetSecurityConfigurationsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetSecurityConfigurationsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetSecurityConfigurationsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetSecurityConfigurationsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetSecurityConfigurationsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetSecurityConfigurationsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetSecurityConfigurationsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if there are more security configurations to return.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of security configurations.
|
|
SecurityConfigurations []*SecurityConfiguration `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfigurations sets the SecurityConfigurations field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput) SetSecurityConfigurations(v []*SecurityConfiguration) *GetSecurityConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.SecurityConfigurations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTableInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the table resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the database in the catalog in which the table resides. For Hive
|
|
// compatibility, this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table for which to retrieve the definition. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetTableInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetTableInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetTableInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GetTableInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableInput) SetName(v string) *GetTableInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTableOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Table object that defines the specified table.
|
|
Table *Table `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTable sets the Table field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableOutput) SetTable(v *Table) *GetTableOutput {
|
|
s.Table = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTableVersionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the tables reside. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The database in the catalog in which the table resides. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table. For Hive compatibility, this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID value of the table version to be retrieved.
|
|
VersionId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableVersionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableVersionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetTableVersionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.VersionId != nil && len(*s.VersionId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("VersionId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GetTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionInput) SetTableName(v string) *GetTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionInput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetTableVersionInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTableVersionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested table version.
|
|
TableVersion *TableVersion `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableVersionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableVersionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableVersion sets the TableVersion field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionOutput) SetTableVersion(v *TableVersion) *GetTableVersionOutput {
|
|
s.TableVersion = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTableVersionsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the tables reside. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The database in the catalog in which the table resides. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of table versions to return in one response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is not the first call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table. For Hive compatibility, this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableVersionsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableVersionsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetTableVersionsInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionsInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetTableVersionsInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionsInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GetTableVersionsInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetTableVersionsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetTableVersionsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionsInput) SetTableName(v string) *GetTableVersionsInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTableVersionsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if the list of available versions does not include
|
|
// the last one.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of strings identifying available versions of the specified table.
|
|
TableVersions []*TableVersion `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableVersionsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTableVersionsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetTableVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableVersions sets the TableVersions field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTableVersionsOutput) SetTableVersions(v []*TableVersion) *GetTableVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.TableVersions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTablesInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the tables reside. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The database in the catalog whose tables to list. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A regular expression pattern. If present, only those tables whose names match
|
|
// the pattern are returned.
|
|
Expression *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of tables to return in a single response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, included if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTablesInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTablesInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetTablesInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetTablesInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTablesInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetTablesInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTablesInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GetTablesInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpression sets the Expression field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTablesInput) SetExpression(v string) *GetTablesInput {
|
|
s.Expression = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTablesInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetTablesInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTablesInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetTablesInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTablesOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, present if the current list segment is not the last.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the requested Table objects.
|
|
TableList []*Table `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTablesOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTablesOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTablesOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetTablesOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableList sets the TableList field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTablesOutput) SetTableList(v []*Table) *GetTablesOutput {
|
|
s.TableList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTriggerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTriggerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTriggerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetTriggerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggerInput) SetName(v string) *GetTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTriggerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested trigger definition.
|
|
Trigger *Trigger `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTriggerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTriggerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTrigger sets the Trigger field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggerOutput) SetTrigger(v *Trigger) *GetTriggerOutput {
|
|
s.Trigger = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTriggersInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job for which to retrieve triggers. The trigger that can
|
|
// start this job will be returned, and if there is no such trigger, all triggers
|
|
// will be returned.
|
|
DependentJobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum size of the response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTriggersInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTriggersInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggersInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetTriggersInput"}
|
|
if s.DependentJobName != nil && len(*s.DependentJobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DependentJobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDependentJobName sets the DependentJobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggersInput) SetDependentJobName(v string) *GetTriggersInput {
|
|
s.DependentJobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggersInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetTriggersInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggersInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetTriggersInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetTriggersOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if not all the requested triggers have yet been returned.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of triggers for the specified job.
|
|
Triggers []*Trigger `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTriggersOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetTriggersOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggersOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetTriggersOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTriggers sets the Triggers field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetTriggersOutput) SetTriggers(v []*Trigger) *GetTriggersOutput {
|
|
s.Triggers = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetUserDefinedFunctionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the function to be retrieved is located.
|
|
// If none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the function is located.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the function.
|
|
//
|
|
// FunctionName is a required field
|
|
FunctionName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetUserDefinedFunctionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetUserDefinedFunctionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetUserDefinedFunctionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FunctionName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionName != nil && len(*s.FunctionName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("FunctionName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFunctionName sets the FunctionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetFunctionName(v string) *GetUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.FunctionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The requested function definition.
|
|
UserDefinedFunction *UserDefinedFunction `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUserDefinedFunction sets the UserDefinedFunction field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput) SetUserDefinedFunction(v *UserDefinedFunction) *GetUserDefinedFunctionOutput {
|
|
s.UserDefinedFunction = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the functions to be retrieved are located.
|
|
// If none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the functions are located.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of functions to return in one response.
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if this is a continuation call.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// An optional function-name pattern string that filters the function definitions
|
|
// returned.
|
|
//
|
|
// Pattern is a required field
|
|
Pattern *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Pattern == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Pattern"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Pattern != nil && len(*s.Pattern) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Pattern", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPattern sets the Pattern field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput) SetPattern(v string) *GetUserDefinedFunctionsInput {
|
|
s.Pattern = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A continuation token, if the list of functions returned does not include
|
|
// the last requested function.
|
|
NextToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of requested function definitions.
|
|
UserDefinedFunctions []*UserDefinedFunction `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUserDefinedFunctions sets the UserDefinedFunctions field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput) SetUserDefinedFunctions(v []*UserDefinedFunction) *GetUserDefinedFunctionsOutput {
|
|
s.UserDefinedFunctions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A classifier that uses grok patterns.
|
|
type GrokClassifier struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An identifier of the data format that the classifier matches, such as Twitter,
|
|
// JSON, Omniture logs, and so on.
|
|
//
|
|
// Classification is a required field
|
|
Classification *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The time this classifier was registered.
|
|
CreationTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Optional custom grok patterns defined by this classifier. For more information,
|
|
// see custom patterns in Writing Custom Classifers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/custom-classifier.html).
|
|
CustomPatterns *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The grok pattern applied to a data store by this classifier. For more information,
|
|
// see built-in patterns in Writing Custom Classifers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/custom-classifier.html).
|
|
//
|
|
// GrokPattern is a required field
|
|
GrokPattern *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The time this classifier was last updated.
|
|
LastUpdated *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The version of this classifier.
|
|
Version *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GrokClassifier) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GrokClassifier) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassification sets the Classification field's value.
|
|
func (s *GrokClassifier) SetClassification(v string) *GrokClassifier {
|
|
s.Classification = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreationTime sets the CreationTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *GrokClassifier) SetCreationTime(v time.Time) *GrokClassifier {
|
|
s.CreationTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCustomPatterns sets the CustomPatterns field's value.
|
|
func (s *GrokClassifier) SetCustomPatterns(v string) *GrokClassifier {
|
|
s.CustomPatterns = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrokPattern sets the GrokPattern field's value.
|
|
func (s *GrokClassifier) SetGrokPattern(v string) *GrokClassifier {
|
|
s.GrokPattern = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastUpdated sets the LastUpdated field's value.
|
|
func (s *GrokClassifier) SetLastUpdated(v time.Time) *GrokClassifier {
|
|
s.LastUpdated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *GrokClassifier) SetName(v string) *GrokClassifier {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersion sets the Version field's value.
|
|
func (s *GrokClassifier) SetVersion(v int64) *GrokClassifier {
|
|
s.Version = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ImportCatalogToGlueInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the catalog to import. Currently, this should be the AWS account
|
|
// ID.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ImportCatalogToGlueInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ImportCatalogToGlueInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ImportCatalogToGlueInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ImportCatalogToGlueInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *ImportCatalogToGlueInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *ImportCatalogToGlueInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ImportCatalogToGlueOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ImportCatalogToGlueOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ImportCatalogToGlueOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a JDBC data store to crawl.
|
|
type JdbcTarget struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the connection to use to connect to the JDBC target.
|
|
ConnectionName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of glob patterns used to exclude from the crawl. For more information,
|
|
// see Catalog Tables with a Crawler (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/add-crawler.html).
|
|
Exclusions []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The path of the JDBC target.
|
|
Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JdbcTarget) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JdbcTarget) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionName sets the ConnectionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *JdbcTarget) SetConnectionName(v string) *JdbcTarget {
|
|
s.ConnectionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExclusions sets the Exclusions field's value.
|
|
func (s *JdbcTarget) SetExclusions(v []*string) *JdbcTarget {
|
|
s.Exclusions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPath sets the Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *JdbcTarget) SetPath(v string) *JdbcTarget {
|
|
s.Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a job definition.
|
|
type Job struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of AWS Glue data processing units (DPUs) allocated to runs of
|
|
// this job. From 2 to 100 DPUs can be allocated; the default is 10. A DPU is
|
|
// a relative measure of processing power that consists of 4 vCPUs of compute
|
|
// capacity and 16 GB of memory. For more information, see the AWS Glue pricing
|
|
// page (https://aws.amazon.com/glue/pricing/).
|
|
AllocatedCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The JobCommand that executes this job.
|
|
Command *JobCommand `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The connections used for this job.
|
|
Connections *ConnectionsList `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The time and date that this job definition was created.
|
|
CreatedOn *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The default arguments for this job, specified as name-value pairs.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can specify arguments here that your own job-execution script consumes,
|
|
// as well as arguments that AWS Glue itself consumes.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about how to specify and consume your own Job arguments,
|
|
// see the Calling AWS Glue APIs in Python (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-python-calling.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about the key-value pairs that AWS Glue consumes to set up
|
|
// your job, see the Special Parameters Used by AWS Glue (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-etl-glue-arguments.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
DefaultArguments map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the job being defined.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// An ExecutionProperty specifying the maximum number of concurrent runs allowed
|
|
// for this job.
|
|
ExecutionProperty *ExecutionProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The last point in time when this job definition was modified.
|
|
LastModifiedOn *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// This field is reserved for future use.
|
|
LogUri *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of times to retry this job after a JobRun fails.
|
|
MaxRetries *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The name you assign to this job definition.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies configuration properties of a job notification.
|
|
NotificationProperty *NotificationProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name or ARN of the IAM role associated with this job.
|
|
Role *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used with this job.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The job timeout in minutes. This is the maximum time that a job run can consume
|
|
// resources before it is terminated and enters TIMEOUT status. The default
|
|
// is 2,880 minutes (48 hours).
|
|
Timeout *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Job) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Job) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllocatedCapacity sets the AllocatedCapacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetAllocatedCapacity(v int64) *Job {
|
|
s.AllocatedCapacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCommand sets the Command field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetCommand(v *JobCommand) *Job {
|
|
s.Command = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnections sets the Connections field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetConnections(v *ConnectionsList) *Job {
|
|
s.Connections = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreatedOn sets the CreatedOn field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetCreatedOn(v time.Time) *Job {
|
|
s.CreatedOn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDefaultArguments sets the DefaultArguments field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetDefaultArguments(v map[string]*string) *Job {
|
|
s.DefaultArguments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetDescription(v string) *Job {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExecutionProperty sets the ExecutionProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetExecutionProperty(v *ExecutionProperty) *Job {
|
|
s.ExecutionProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModifiedOn sets the LastModifiedOn field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetLastModifiedOn(v time.Time) *Job {
|
|
s.LastModifiedOn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogUri sets the LogUri field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetLogUri(v string) *Job {
|
|
s.LogUri = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxRetries sets the MaxRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetMaxRetries(v int64) *Job {
|
|
s.MaxRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetName(v string) *Job {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotificationProperty sets the NotificationProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetNotificationProperty(v *NotificationProperty) *Job {
|
|
s.NotificationProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRole sets the Role field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetRole(v string) *Job {
|
|
s.Role = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *Job {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimeout sets the Timeout field's value.
|
|
func (s *Job) SetTimeout(v int64) *Job {
|
|
s.Timeout = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Defines a point which a job can resume processing.
|
|
type JobBookmarkEntry struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The attempt ID number.
|
|
Attempt *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The bookmark itself.
|
|
JobBookmark *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the job in question.
|
|
JobName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The run ID number.
|
|
Run *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Version of the job.
|
|
Version *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobBookmarkEntry) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobBookmarkEntry) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAttempt sets the Attempt field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobBookmarkEntry) SetAttempt(v int64) *JobBookmarkEntry {
|
|
s.Attempt = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobBookmark sets the JobBookmark field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobBookmarkEntry) SetJobBookmark(v string) *JobBookmarkEntry {
|
|
s.JobBookmark = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobBookmarkEntry) SetJobName(v string) *JobBookmarkEntry {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRun sets the Run field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobBookmarkEntry) SetRun(v int64) *JobBookmarkEntry {
|
|
s.Run = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersion sets the Version field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobBookmarkEntry) SetVersion(v int64) *JobBookmarkEntry {
|
|
s.Version = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies how Job bookmark data should be encrypted.
|
|
type JobBookmarksEncryption struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption mode to use for Job bookmarks data.
|
|
JobBookmarksEncryptionMode *string `type:"string" enum:"JobBookmarksEncryptionMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS ARN of the KMS key to be used to encrypt the data.
|
|
KmsKeyArn *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobBookmarksEncryption) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobBookmarksEncryption) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobBookmarksEncryptionMode sets the JobBookmarksEncryptionMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobBookmarksEncryption) SetJobBookmarksEncryptionMode(v string) *JobBookmarksEncryption {
|
|
s.JobBookmarksEncryptionMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKmsKeyArn sets the KmsKeyArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobBookmarksEncryption) SetKmsKeyArn(v string) *JobBookmarksEncryption {
|
|
s.KmsKeyArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies code executed when a job is run.
|
|
type JobCommand struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job command: this must be glueetl.
|
|
Name *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the S3 path to a script that executes a job (required).
|
|
ScriptLocation *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobCommand) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobCommand) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobCommand) SetName(v string) *JobCommand {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScriptLocation sets the ScriptLocation field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobCommand) SetScriptLocation(v string) *JobCommand {
|
|
s.ScriptLocation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Contains information about a job run.
|
|
type JobRun struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of AWS Glue data processing units (DPUs) allocated to this JobRun.
|
|
// From 2 to 100 DPUs can be allocated; the default is 10. A DPU is a relative
|
|
// measure of processing power that consists of 4 vCPUs of compute capacity
|
|
// and 16 GB of memory. For more information, see the AWS Glue pricing page
|
|
// (https://aws.amazon.com/glue/pricing/).
|
|
AllocatedCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The job arguments associated with this run. These override equivalent default
|
|
// arguments set for the job.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can specify arguments here that your own job-execution script consumes,
|
|
// as well as arguments that AWS Glue itself consumes.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about how to specify and consume your own job arguments,
|
|
// see the Calling AWS Glue APIs in Python (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-python-calling.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about the key-value pairs that AWS Glue consumes to set up
|
|
// your job, see the Special Parameters Used by AWS Glue (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-etl-glue-arguments.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
Arguments map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of the attempt to run this job.
|
|
Attempt *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time this job run completed.
|
|
CompletedOn *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// An error message associated with this job run.
|
|
ErrorMessage *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The amount of time (in seconds) that the job run consumed resources.
|
|
ExecutionTime *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of this job run.
|
|
Id *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition being used in this run.
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The current state of the job run.
|
|
JobRunState *string `type:"string" enum:"JobRunState"`
|
|
|
|
// The last time this job run was modified.
|
|
LastModifiedOn *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the log group for secure logging, that can be server-side encrypted
|
|
// in CloudWatch using KMS. This name can be /aws-glue/jobs/, in which case
|
|
// the default encryption is NONE. If you add a role name and SecurityConfiguration
|
|
// name (in other words, /aws-glue/jobs-yourRoleName-yourSecurityConfigurationName/),
|
|
// then that security configuration will be used to encrypt the log group.
|
|
LogGroupName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies configuration properties of a job run notification.
|
|
NotificationProperty *NotificationProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of predecessors to this job run.
|
|
PredecessorRuns []*Predecessor `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the previous run of this job. For example, the JobRunId specified
|
|
// in the StartJobRun action.
|
|
PreviousRunId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used with this job
|
|
// run.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time at which this job run was started.
|
|
StartedOn *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The JobRun timeout in minutes. This is the maximum time that a job run can
|
|
// consume resources before it is terminated and enters TIMEOUT status. The
|
|
// default is 2,880 minutes (48 hours). This overrides the timeout value set
|
|
// in the parent job.
|
|
Timeout *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger that started this job run.
|
|
TriggerName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobRun) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobRun) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllocatedCapacity sets the AllocatedCapacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetAllocatedCapacity(v int64) *JobRun {
|
|
s.AllocatedCapacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArguments sets the Arguments field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetArguments(v map[string]*string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.Arguments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAttempt sets the Attempt field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetAttempt(v int64) *JobRun {
|
|
s.Attempt = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCompletedOn sets the CompletedOn field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetCompletedOn(v time.Time) *JobRun {
|
|
s.CompletedOn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorMessage sets the ErrorMessage field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetErrorMessage(v string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.ErrorMessage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExecutionTime sets the ExecutionTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetExecutionTime(v int64) *JobRun {
|
|
s.ExecutionTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetId(v string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetJobName(v string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobRunState sets the JobRunState field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetJobRunState(v string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.JobRunState = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModifiedOn sets the LastModifiedOn field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetLastModifiedOn(v time.Time) *JobRun {
|
|
s.LastModifiedOn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogGroupName sets the LogGroupName field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetLogGroupName(v string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.LogGroupName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotificationProperty sets the NotificationProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetNotificationProperty(v *NotificationProperty) *JobRun {
|
|
s.NotificationProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPredecessorRuns sets the PredecessorRuns field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetPredecessorRuns(v []*Predecessor) *JobRun {
|
|
s.PredecessorRuns = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPreviousRunId sets the PreviousRunId field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetPreviousRunId(v string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.PreviousRunId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStartedOn sets the StartedOn field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetStartedOn(v time.Time) *JobRun {
|
|
s.StartedOn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimeout sets the Timeout field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetTimeout(v int64) *JobRun {
|
|
s.Timeout = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTriggerName sets the TriggerName field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobRun) SetTriggerName(v string) *JobRun {
|
|
s.TriggerName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies information used to update an existing job definition. Note that
|
|
// the previous job definition will be completely overwritten by this information.
|
|
type JobUpdate struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of AWS Glue data processing units (DPUs) to allocate to this Job.
|
|
// From 2 to 100 DPUs can be allocated; the default is 10. A DPU is a relative
|
|
// measure of processing power that consists of 4 vCPUs of compute capacity
|
|
// and 16 GB of memory. For more information, see the AWS Glue pricing page
|
|
// (https://aws.amazon.com/glue/pricing/).
|
|
AllocatedCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The JobCommand that executes this job (required).
|
|
Command *JobCommand `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The connections used for this job.
|
|
Connections *ConnectionsList `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The default arguments for this job.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can specify arguments here that your own job-execution script consumes,
|
|
// as well as arguments that AWS Glue itself consumes.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about how to specify and consume your own Job arguments,
|
|
// see the Calling AWS Glue APIs in Python (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-python-calling.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about the key-value pairs that AWS Glue consumes to set up
|
|
// your job, see the Special Parameters Used by AWS Glue (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-etl-glue-arguments.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
DefaultArguments map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the job being defined.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// An ExecutionProperty specifying the maximum number of concurrent runs allowed
|
|
// for this job.
|
|
ExecutionProperty *ExecutionProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// This field is reserved for future use.
|
|
LogUri *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The maximum number of times to retry this job if it fails.
|
|
MaxRetries *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies configuration properties of a job notification.
|
|
NotificationProperty *NotificationProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name or ARN of the IAM role associated with this job (required).
|
|
Role *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used with this job.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The job timeout in minutes. This is the maximum time that a job run can consume
|
|
// resources before it is terminated and enters TIMEOUT status. The default
|
|
// is 2,880 minutes (48 hours).
|
|
Timeout *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobUpdate) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JobUpdate) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "JobUpdate"}
|
|
if s.SecurityConfiguration != nil && len(*s.SecurityConfiguration) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SecurityConfiguration", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Timeout != nil && *s.Timeout < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Timeout", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NotificationProperty != nil {
|
|
if err := s.NotificationProperty.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("NotificationProperty", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllocatedCapacity sets the AllocatedCapacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetAllocatedCapacity(v int64) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.AllocatedCapacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCommand sets the Command field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetCommand(v *JobCommand) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.Command = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnections sets the Connections field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetConnections(v *ConnectionsList) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.Connections = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDefaultArguments sets the DefaultArguments field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetDefaultArguments(v map[string]*string) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.DefaultArguments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetDescription(v string) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExecutionProperty sets the ExecutionProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetExecutionProperty(v *ExecutionProperty) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.ExecutionProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogUri sets the LogUri field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetLogUri(v string) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.LogUri = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxRetries sets the MaxRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetMaxRetries(v int64) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.MaxRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotificationProperty sets the NotificationProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetNotificationProperty(v *NotificationProperty) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.NotificationProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRole sets the Role field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetRole(v string) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.Role = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimeout sets the Timeout field's value.
|
|
func (s *JobUpdate) SetTimeout(v int64) *JobUpdate {
|
|
s.Timeout = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A classifier for JSON content.
|
|
type JsonClassifier struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The time this classifier was registered.
|
|
CreationTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// A JsonPath string defining the JSON data for the classifier to classify.
|
|
// AWS Glue supports a subset of JsonPath, as described in Writing JsonPath
|
|
// Custom Classifiers (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/custom-classifier.html#custom-classifier-json).
|
|
//
|
|
// JsonPath is a required field
|
|
JsonPath *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The time this classifier was last updated.
|
|
LastUpdated *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The version of this classifier.
|
|
Version *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JsonClassifier) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JsonClassifier) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreationTime sets the CreationTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *JsonClassifier) SetCreationTime(v time.Time) *JsonClassifier {
|
|
s.CreationTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJsonPath sets the JsonPath field's value.
|
|
func (s *JsonClassifier) SetJsonPath(v string) *JsonClassifier {
|
|
s.JsonPath = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastUpdated sets the LastUpdated field's value.
|
|
func (s *JsonClassifier) SetLastUpdated(v time.Time) *JsonClassifier {
|
|
s.LastUpdated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *JsonClassifier) SetName(v string) *JsonClassifier {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersion sets the Version field's value.
|
|
func (s *JsonClassifier) SetVersion(v int64) *JsonClassifier {
|
|
s.Version = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Status and error information about the most recent crawl.
|
|
type LastCrawlInfo struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If an error occurred, the error information about the last crawl.
|
|
ErrorMessage *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The log group for the last crawl.
|
|
LogGroup *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The log stream for the last crawl.
|
|
LogStream *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix for a message about this crawl.
|
|
MessagePrefix *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The time at which the crawl started.
|
|
StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Status of the last crawl.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" enum:"LastCrawlStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LastCrawlInfo) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LastCrawlInfo) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorMessage sets the ErrorMessage field's value.
|
|
func (s *LastCrawlInfo) SetErrorMessage(v string) *LastCrawlInfo {
|
|
s.ErrorMessage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogGroup sets the LogGroup field's value.
|
|
func (s *LastCrawlInfo) SetLogGroup(v string) *LastCrawlInfo {
|
|
s.LogGroup = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogStream sets the LogStream field's value.
|
|
func (s *LastCrawlInfo) SetLogStream(v string) *LastCrawlInfo {
|
|
s.LogStream = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMessagePrefix sets the MessagePrefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *LastCrawlInfo) SetMessagePrefix(v string) *LastCrawlInfo {
|
|
s.MessagePrefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *LastCrawlInfo) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *LastCrawlInfo {
|
|
s.StartTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *LastCrawlInfo) SetStatus(v string) *LastCrawlInfo {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The location of resources.
|
|
type Location struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A DynamoDB Table location.
|
|
DynamoDB []*CodeGenNodeArg `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A JDBC location.
|
|
Jdbc []*CodeGenNodeArg `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// An Amazon S3 location.
|
|
S3 []*CodeGenNodeArg `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Location) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Location) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Location) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Location"}
|
|
if s.DynamoDB != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.DynamoDB {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "DynamoDB", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Jdbc != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Jdbc {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Jdbc", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.S3 != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.S3 {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "S3", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDynamoDB sets the DynamoDB field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetDynamoDB(v []*CodeGenNodeArg) *Location {
|
|
s.DynamoDB = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJdbc sets the Jdbc field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetJdbc(v []*CodeGenNodeArg) *Location {
|
|
s.Jdbc = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetS3 sets the S3 field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetS3(v []*CodeGenNodeArg) *Location {
|
|
s.S3 = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Defines a mapping.
|
|
type MappingEntry struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The source path.
|
|
SourcePath *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the source table.
|
|
SourceTable *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The source type.
|
|
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The target path.
|
|
TargetPath *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The target table.
|
|
TargetTable *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The target type.
|
|
TargetType *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MappingEntry) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MappingEntry) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSourcePath sets the SourcePath field's value.
|
|
func (s *MappingEntry) SetSourcePath(v string) *MappingEntry {
|
|
s.SourcePath = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSourceTable sets the SourceTable field's value.
|
|
func (s *MappingEntry) SetSourceTable(v string) *MappingEntry {
|
|
s.SourceTable = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
|
|
func (s *MappingEntry) SetSourceType(v string) *MappingEntry {
|
|
s.SourceType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargetPath sets the TargetPath field's value.
|
|
func (s *MappingEntry) SetTargetPath(v string) *MappingEntry {
|
|
s.TargetPath = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargetTable sets the TargetTable field's value.
|
|
func (s *MappingEntry) SetTargetTable(v string) *MappingEntry {
|
|
s.TargetTable = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargetType sets the TargetType field's value.
|
|
func (s *MappingEntry) SetTargetType(v string) *MappingEntry {
|
|
s.TargetType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies configuration properties of a notification.
|
|
type NotificationProperty struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// After a job run starts, the number of minutes to wait before sending a job
|
|
// run delay notification.
|
|
NotifyDelayAfter *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NotificationProperty) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NotificationProperty) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *NotificationProperty) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "NotificationProperty"}
|
|
if s.NotifyDelayAfter != nil && *s.NotifyDelayAfter < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("NotifyDelayAfter", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotifyDelayAfter sets the NotifyDelayAfter field's value.
|
|
func (s *NotificationProperty) SetNotifyDelayAfter(v int64) *NotificationProperty {
|
|
s.NotifyDelayAfter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the sort order of a sorted column.
|
|
type Order struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the column.
|
|
//
|
|
// Column is a required field
|
|
Column *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates that the column is sorted in ascending order (== 1), or in descending
|
|
// order (==0).
|
|
//
|
|
// SortOrder is a required field
|
|
SortOrder *int64 `type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Order) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Order) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Order) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Order"}
|
|
if s.Column == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Column"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Column != nil && len(*s.Column) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Column", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SortOrder == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SortOrder"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetColumn sets the Column field's value.
|
|
func (s *Order) SetColumn(v string) *Order {
|
|
s.Column = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSortOrder sets the SortOrder field's value.
|
|
func (s *Order) SetSortOrder(v int64) *Order {
|
|
s.SortOrder = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Represents a slice of table data.
|
|
type Partition struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The time at which the partition was created.
|
|
CreationTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the table in question is located.
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The last time at which the partition was accessed.
|
|
LastAccessTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The last time at which column statistics were computed for this partition.
|
|
LastAnalyzedTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// These key-value pairs define partition parameters.
|
|
Parameters map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Provides information about the physical location where the partition is stored.
|
|
StorageDescriptor *StorageDescriptor `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table in question.
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The values of the partition.
|
|
Values []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Partition) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Partition) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreationTime sets the CreationTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Partition) SetCreationTime(v time.Time) *Partition {
|
|
s.CreationTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Partition) SetDatabaseName(v string) *Partition {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastAccessTime sets the LastAccessTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Partition) SetLastAccessTime(v time.Time) *Partition {
|
|
s.LastAccessTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastAnalyzedTime sets the LastAnalyzedTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Partition) SetLastAnalyzedTime(v time.Time) *Partition {
|
|
s.LastAnalyzedTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *Partition) SetParameters(v map[string]*string) *Partition {
|
|
s.Parameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageDescriptor sets the StorageDescriptor field's value.
|
|
func (s *Partition) SetStorageDescriptor(v *StorageDescriptor) *Partition {
|
|
s.StorageDescriptor = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Partition) SetTableName(v string) *Partition {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetValues sets the Values field's value.
|
|
func (s *Partition) SetValues(v []*string) *Partition {
|
|
s.Values = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Contains information about a partition error.
|
|
type PartitionError struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Details about the partition error.
|
|
ErrorDetail *ErrorDetail `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The values that define the partition.
|
|
PartitionValues []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PartitionError) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PartitionError) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorDetail sets the ErrorDetail field's value.
|
|
func (s *PartitionError) SetErrorDetail(v *ErrorDetail) *PartitionError {
|
|
s.ErrorDetail = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionValues sets the PartitionValues field's value.
|
|
func (s *PartitionError) SetPartitionValues(v []*string) *PartitionError {
|
|
s.PartitionValues = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The structure used to create and update a partion.
|
|
type PartitionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The last time at which the partition was accessed.
|
|
LastAccessTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The last time at which column statistics were computed for this partition.
|
|
LastAnalyzedTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// These key-value pairs define partition parameters.
|
|
Parameters map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Provides information about the physical location where the partition is stored.
|
|
StorageDescriptor *StorageDescriptor `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The values of the partition.
|
|
Values []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PartitionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PartitionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PartitionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PartitionInput"}
|
|
if s.StorageDescriptor != nil {
|
|
if err := s.StorageDescriptor.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("StorageDescriptor", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastAccessTime sets the LastAccessTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *PartitionInput) SetLastAccessTime(v time.Time) *PartitionInput {
|
|
s.LastAccessTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastAnalyzedTime sets the LastAnalyzedTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *PartitionInput) SetLastAnalyzedTime(v time.Time) *PartitionInput {
|
|
s.LastAnalyzedTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *PartitionInput) SetParameters(v map[string]*string) *PartitionInput {
|
|
s.Parameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageDescriptor sets the StorageDescriptor field's value.
|
|
func (s *PartitionInput) SetStorageDescriptor(v *StorageDescriptor) *PartitionInput {
|
|
s.StorageDescriptor = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetValues sets the Values field's value.
|
|
func (s *PartitionInput) SetValues(v []*string) *PartitionInput {
|
|
s.Values = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Contains a list of values defining partitions.
|
|
type PartitionValueList struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of values.
|
|
//
|
|
// Values is a required field
|
|
Values []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PartitionValueList) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PartitionValueList) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PartitionValueList) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PartitionValueList"}
|
|
if s.Values == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Values"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetValues sets the Values field's value.
|
|
func (s *PartitionValueList) SetValues(v []*string) *PartitionValueList {
|
|
s.Values = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the physical requirements for a connection.
|
|
type PhysicalConnectionRequirements struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The connection's availability zone. This field is redundant, since the specified
|
|
// subnet implies the availability zone to be used. The field must be populated
|
|
// now, but will be deprecated in the future.
|
|
AvailabilityZone *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The security group ID list used by the connection.
|
|
SecurityGroupIdList []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The subnet ID used by the connection.
|
|
SubnetId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PhysicalConnectionRequirements) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PhysicalConnectionRequirements) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PhysicalConnectionRequirements) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PhysicalConnectionRequirements"}
|
|
if s.AvailabilityZone != nil && len(*s.AvailabilityZone) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AvailabilityZone", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SubnetId != nil && len(*s.SubnetId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SubnetId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
|
|
func (s *PhysicalConnectionRequirements) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *PhysicalConnectionRequirements {
|
|
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityGroupIdList sets the SecurityGroupIdList field's value.
|
|
func (s *PhysicalConnectionRequirements) SetSecurityGroupIdList(v []*string) *PhysicalConnectionRequirements {
|
|
s.SecurityGroupIdList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSubnetId sets the SubnetId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PhysicalConnectionRequirements) SetSubnetId(v string) *PhysicalConnectionRequirements {
|
|
s.SubnetId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A job run that was used in the predicate of a conditional trigger that triggered
|
|
// this job run.
|
|
type Predecessor struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition used by the predecessor job run.
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The job-run ID of the predecessor job run.
|
|
RunId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Predecessor) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Predecessor) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Predecessor) SetJobName(v string) *Predecessor {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRunId sets the RunId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Predecessor) SetRunId(v string) *Predecessor {
|
|
s.RunId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Defines the predicate of the trigger, which determines when it fires.
|
|
type Predicate struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the conditions that determine when the trigger will fire.
|
|
Conditions []*Condition `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Optional field if only one condition is listed. If multiple conditions are
|
|
// listed, then this field is required.
|
|
Logical *string `type:"string" enum:"Logical"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Predicate) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Predicate) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Predicate) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Predicate"}
|
|
if s.Conditions != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Conditions {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Conditions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConditions sets the Conditions field's value.
|
|
func (s *Predicate) SetConditions(v []*Condition) *Predicate {
|
|
s.Conditions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogical sets the Logical field's value.
|
|
func (s *Predicate) SetLogical(v string) *Predicate {
|
|
s.Logical = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog for which to set the security configuration. If
|
|
// none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The security configuration to set.
|
|
//
|
|
// DataCatalogEncryptionSettings is a required field
|
|
DataCatalogEncryptionSettings *DataCatalogEncryptionSettings `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DataCatalogEncryptionSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DataCatalogEncryptionSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DataCatalogEncryptionSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DataCatalogEncryptionSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DataCatalogEncryptionSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings sets the DataCatalogEncryptionSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput) SetDataCatalogEncryptionSettings(v *DataCatalogEncryptionSettings) *PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsInput {
|
|
s.DataCatalogEncryptionSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutDataCatalogEncryptionSettingsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ResetJobBookmarkInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job in question.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobName is a required field
|
|
JobName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ResetJobBookmarkInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ResetJobBookmarkInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ResetJobBookmarkInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResetJobBookmarkInput"}
|
|
if s.JobName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobName"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *ResetJobBookmarkInput) SetJobName(v string) *ResetJobBookmarkInput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ResetJobBookmarkOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The reset bookmark entry.
|
|
JobBookmarkEntry *JobBookmarkEntry `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ResetJobBookmarkOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ResetJobBookmarkOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobBookmarkEntry sets the JobBookmarkEntry field's value.
|
|
func (s *ResetJobBookmarkOutput) SetJobBookmarkEntry(v *JobBookmarkEntry) *ResetJobBookmarkOutput {
|
|
s.JobBookmarkEntry = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// URIs for function resources.
|
|
type ResourceUri struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of the resource.
|
|
ResourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"ResourceType"`
|
|
|
|
// The URI for accessing the resource.
|
|
Uri *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ResourceUri) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ResourceUri) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ResourceUri) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResourceUri"}
|
|
if s.Uri != nil && len(*s.Uri) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Uri", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ResourceUri) SetResourceType(v string) *ResourceUri {
|
|
s.ResourceType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUri sets the Uri field's value.
|
|
func (s *ResourceUri) SetUri(v string) *ResourceUri {
|
|
s.Uri = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies how S3 data should be encrypted.
|
|
type S3Encryption struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS ARN of the KMS key to be used to encrypt the data.
|
|
KmsKeyArn *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption mode to use for S3 data.
|
|
S3EncryptionMode *string `type:"string" enum:"S3EncryptionMode"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s S3Encryption) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s S3Encryption) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKmsKeyArn sets the KmsKeyArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *S3Encryption) SetKmsKeyArn(v string) *S3Encryption {
|
|
s.KmsKeyArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetS3EncryptionMode sets the S3EncryptionMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *S3Encryption) SetS3EncryptionMode(v string) *S3Encryption {
|
|
s.S3EncryptionMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a data store in Amazon S3.
|
|
type S3Target struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of glob patterns used to exclude from the crawl. For more information,
|
|
// see Catalog Tables with a Crawler (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/add-crawler.html).
|
|
Exclusions []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The path to the Amazon S3 target.
|
|
Path *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s S3Target) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s S3Target) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExclusions sets the Exclusions field's value.
|
|
func (s *S3Target) SetExclusions(v []*string) *S3Target {
|
|
s.Exclusions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPath sets the Path field's value.
|
|
func (s *S3Target) SetPath(v string) *S3Target {
|
|
s.Path = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A scheduling object using a cron statement to schedule an event.
|
|
type Schedule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A cron expression used to specify the schedule (see Time-Based Schedules
|
|
// for Jobs and Crawlers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/monitor-data-warehouse-schedule.html).
|
|
// For example, to run something every day at 12:15 UTC, you would specify:
|
|
// cron(15 12 * * ? *).
|
|
ScheduleExpression *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The state of the schedule.
|
|
State *string `type:"string" enum:"ScheduleState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Schedule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Schedule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScheduleExpression sets the ScheduleExpression field's value.
|
|
func (s *Schedule) SetScheduleExpression(v string) *Schedule {
|
|
s.ScheduleExpression = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *Schedule) SetState(v string) *Schedule {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Crawler policy for update and deletion behavior.
|
|
type SchemaChangePolicy struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The deletion behavior when the crawler finds a deleted object.
|
|
DeleteBehavior *string `type:"string" enum:"DeleteBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// The update behavior when the crawler finds a changed schema.
|
|
UpdateBehavior *string `type:"string" enum:"UpdateBehavior"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SchemaChangePolicy) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SchemaChangePolicy) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleteBehavior sets the DeleteBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *SchemaChangePolicy) SetDeleteBehavior(v string) *SchemaChangePolicy {
|
|
s.DeleteBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUpdateBehavior sets the UpdateBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *SchemaChangePolicy) SetUpdateBehavior(v string) *SchemaChangePolicy {
|
|
s.UpdateBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a security configuration.
|
|
type SecurityConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The time at which this security configuration was created.
|
|
CreatedTimeStamp *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The encryption configuration associated with this security configuration.
|
|
EncryptionConfiguration *EncryptionConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the security configuration.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SecurityConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SecurityConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreatedTimeStamp sets the CreatedTimeStamp field's value.
|
|
func (s *SecurityConfiguration) SetCreatedTimeStamp(v time.Time) *SecurityConfiguration {
|
|
s.CreatedTimeStamp = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncryptionConfiguration sets the EncryptionConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *SecurityConfiguration) SetEncryptionConfiguration(v *EncryptionConfiguration) *SecurityConfiguration {
|
|
s.EncryptionConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *SecurityConfiguration) SetName(v string) *SecurityConfiguration {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Defines a non-overlapping region of a table's partitions, allowing multiple
|
|
// requests to be executed in parallel.
|
|
type Segment struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The zero-based index number of the this segment. For example, if the total
|
|
// number of segments is 4, SegmentNumber values will range from zero through
|
|
// three.
|
|
//
|
|
// SegmentNumber is a required field
|
|
SegmentNumber *int64 `type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The total numer of segments.
|
|
//
|
|
// TotalSegments is a required field
|
|
TotalSegments *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Segment) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Segment) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Segment) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Segment"}
|
|
if s.SegmentNumber == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SegmentNumber"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TotalSegments == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TotalSegments"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TotalSegments != nil && *s.TotalSegments < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("TotalSegments", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentNumber sets the SegmentNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *Segment) SetSegmentNumber(v int64) *Segment {
|
|
s.SegmentNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTotalSegments sets the TotalSegments field's value.
|
|
func (s *Segment) SetTotalSegments(v int64) *Segment {
|
|
s.TotalSegments = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Information about a serialization/deserialization program (SerDe) which serves
|
|
// as an extractor and loader.
|
|
type SerDeInfo struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the SerDe.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// These key-value pairs define initialization parameters for the SerDe.
|
|
Parameters map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Usually the class that implements the SerDe. An example is: org.apache.hadoop.hive.serde2.columnar.ColumnarSerDe.
|
|
SerializationLibrary *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SerDeInfo) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SerDeInfo) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *SerDeInfo) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SerDeInfo"}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SerializationLibrary != nil && len(*s.SerializationLibrary) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SerializationLibrary", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *SerDeInfo) SetName(v string) *SerDeInfo {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *SerDeInfo) SetParameters(v map[string]*string) *SerDeInfo {
|
|
s.Parameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSerializationLibrary sets the SerializationLibrary field's value.
|
|
func (s *SerDeInfo) SetSerializationLibrary(v string) *SerDeInfo {
|
|
s.SerializationLibrary = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies skewed values in a table. Skewed are ones that occur with very
|
|
// high frequency.
|
|
type SkewedInfo struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of names of columns that contain skewed values.
|
|
SkewedColumnNames []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A mapping of skewed values to the columns that contain them.
|
|
SkewedColumnValueLocationMaps map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of values that appear so frequently as to be considered skewed.
|
|
SkewedColumnValues []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SkewedInfo) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SkewedInfo) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSkewedColumnNames sets the SkewedColumnNames field's value.
|
|
func (s *SkewedInfo) SetSkewedColumnNames(v []*string) *SkewedInfo {
|
|
s.SkewedColumnNames = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSkewedColumnValueLocationMaps sets the SkewedColumnValueLocationMaps field's value.
|
|
func (s *SkewedInfo) SetSkewedColumnValueLocationMaps(v map[string]*string) *SkewedInfo {
|
|
s.SkewedColumnValueLocationMaps = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSkewedColumnValues sets the SkewedColumnValues field's value.
|
|
func (s *SkewedInfo) SetSkewedColumnValues(v []*string) *SkewedInfo {
|
|
s.SkewedColumnValues = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartCrawlerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the crawler to start.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartCrawlerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartCrawlerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StartCrawlerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartCrawlerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartCrawlerInput) SetName(v string) *StartCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartCrawlerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartCrawlerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartCrawlerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartCrawlerScheduleInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the crawler to schedule.
|
|
//
|
|
// CrawlerName is a required field
|
|
CrawlerName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartCrawlerScheduleInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartCrawlerScheduleInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StartCrawlerScheduleInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartCrawlerScheduleInput"}
|
|
if s.CrawlerName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CrawlerName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CrawlerName != nil && len(*s.CrawlerName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CrawlerName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerName sets the CrawlerName field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartCrawlerScheduleInput) SetCrawlerName(v string) *StartCrawlerScheduleInput {
|
|
s.CrawlerName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartCrawlerScheduleOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartCrawlerScheduleOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartCrawlerScheduleOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartJobRunInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of AWS Glue data processing units (DPUs) to allocate to this JobRun.
|
|
// From 2 to 100 DPUs can be allocated; the default is 10. A DPU is a relative
|
|
// measure of processing power that consists of 4 vCPUs of compute capacity
|
|
// and 16 GB of memory. For more information, see the AWS Glue pricing page
|
|
// (https://aws.amazon.com/glue/pricing/).
|
|
AllocatedCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The job arguments specifically for this run. They override the equivalent
|
|
// default arguments set for in the job definition itself.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can specify arguments here that your own job-execution script consumes,
|
|
// as well as arguments that AWS Glue itself consumes.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about how to specify and consume your own Job arguments,
|
|
// see the Calling AWS Glue APIs in Python (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-python-calling.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// For information about the key-value pairs that AWS Glue consumes to set up
|
|
// your job, see the Special Parameters Used by AWS Glue (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/aws-glue-programming-etl-glue-arguments.html)
|
|
// topic in the developer guide.
|
|
Arguments map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the job definition to use.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobName is a required field
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of a previous JobRun to retry.
|
|
JobRunId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies configuration properties of a job run notification.
|
|
NotificationProperty *NotificationProperty `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used with this job
|
|
// run.
|
|
SecurityConfiguration *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The JobRun timeout in minutes. This is the maximum time that a job run can
|
|
// consume resources before it is terminated and enters TIMEOUT status. The
|
|
// default is 2,880 minutes (48 hours). This overrides the timeout value set
|
|
// in the parent job.
|
|
Timeout *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartJobRunInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartJobRunInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartJobRunInput"}
|
|
if s.JobName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobRunId != nil && len(*s.JobRunId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobRunId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SecurityConfiguration != nil && len(*s.SecurityConfiguration) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SecurityConfiguration", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Timeout != nil && *s.Timeout < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Timeout", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NotificationProperty != nil {
|
|
if err := s.NotificationProperty.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("NotificationProperty", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllocatedCapacity sets the AllocatedCapacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunInput) SetAllocatedCapacity(v int64) *StartJobRunInput {
|
|
s.AllocatedCapacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArguments sets the Arguments field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunInput) SetArguments(v map[string]*string) *StartJobRunInput {
|
|
s.Arguments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunInput) SetJobName(v string) *StartJobRunInput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobRunId sets the JobRunId field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunInput) SetJobRunId(v string) *StartJobRunInput {
|
|
s.JobRunId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotificationProperty sets the NotificationProperty field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunInput) SetNotificationProperty(v *NotificationProperty) *StartJobRunInput {
|
|
s.NotificationProperty = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityConfiguration sets the SecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunInput) SetSecurityConfiguration(v string) *StartJobRunInput {
|
|
s.SecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimeout sets the Timeout field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunInput) SetTimeout(v int64) *StartJobRunInput {
|
|
s.Timeout = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartJobRunOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID assigned to this job run.
|
|
JobRunId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartJobRunOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartJobRunOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobRunId sets the JobRunId field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartJobRunOutput) SetJobRunId(v string) *StartJobRunOutput {
|
|
s.JobRunId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartTriggerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger to start.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartTriggerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartTriggerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StartTriggerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartTriggerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartTriggerInput) SetName(v string) *StartTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartTriggerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger that was started.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartTriggerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartTriggerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartTriggerOutput) SetName(v string) *StartTriggerOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StopCrawlerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the crawler to stop.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopCrawlerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopCrawlerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StopCrawlerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StopCrawlerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopCrawlerInput) SetName(v string) *StopCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StopCrawlerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopCrawlerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopCrawlerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StopCrawlerScheduleInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the crawler whose schedule state to set.
|
|
//
|
|
// CrawlerName is a required field
|
|
CrawlerName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopCrawlerScheduleInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopCrawlerScheduleInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StopCrawlerScheduleInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StopCrawlerScheduleInput"}
|
|
if s.CrawlerName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CrawlerName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CrawlerName != nil && len(*s.CrawlerName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CrawlerName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerName sets the CrawlerName field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopCrawlerScheduleInput) SetCrawlerName(v string) *StopCrawlerScheduleInput {
|
|
s.CrawlerName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StopCrawlerScheduleOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopCrawlerScheduleOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopCrawlerScheduleOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StopTriggerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger to stop.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopTriggerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopTriggerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StopTriggerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StopTriggerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopTriggerInput) SetName(v string) *StopTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StopTriggerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger that was stopped.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopTriggerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopTriggerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopTriggerOutput) SetName(v string) *StopTriggerOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes the physical storage of table data.
|
|
type StorageDescriptor struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of reducer grouping columns, clustering columns, and bucketing columns
|
|
// in the table.
|
|
BucketColumns []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the Columns in the table.
|
|
Columns []*Column `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// True if the data in the table is compressed, or False if not.
|
|
Compressed *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The input format: SequenceFileInputFormat (binary), or TextInputFormat, or
|
|
// a custom format.
|
|
InputFormat *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The physical location of the table. By default this takes the form of the
|
|
// warehouse location, followed by the database location in the warehouse, followed
|
|
// by the table name.
|
|
Location *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Must be specified if the table contains any dimension columns.
|
|
NumberOfBuckets *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The output format: SequenceFileOutputFormat (binary), or IgnoreKeyTextOutputFormat,
|
|
// or a custom format.
|
|
OutputFormat *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// User-supplied properties in key-value form.
|
|
Parameters map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Serialization/deserialization (SerDe) information.
|
|
SerdeInfo *SerDeInfo `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Information about values that appear very frequently in a column (skewed
|
|
// values).
|
|
SkewedInfo *SkewedInfo `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list specifying the sort order of each bucket in the table.
|
|
SortColumns []*Order `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// True if the table data is stored in subdirectories, or False if not.
|
|
StoredAsSubDirectories *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StorageDescriptor) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StorageDescriptor) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StorageDescriptor"}
|
|
if s.Columns != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Columns {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Columns", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SerdeInfo != nil {
|
|
if err := s.SerdeInfo.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("SerdeInfo", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SortColumns != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.SortColumns {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "SortColumns", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucketColumns sets the BucketColumns field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetBucketColumns(v []*string) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.BucketColumns = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetColumns sets the Columns field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetColumns(v []*Column) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.Columns = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCompressed sets the Compressed field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetCompressed(v bool) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.Compressed = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputFormat sets the InputFormat field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetInputFormat(v string) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.InputFormat = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocation sets the Location field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetLocation(v string) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.Location = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumberOfBuckets sets the NumberOfBuckets field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetNumberOfBuckets(v int64) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.NumberOfBuckets = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputFormat sets the OutputFormat field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetOutputFormat(v string) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.OutputFormat = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetParameters(v map[string]*string) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.Parameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSerdeInfo sets the SerdeInfo field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetSerdeInfo(v *SerDeInfo) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.SerdeInfo = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSkewedInfo sets the SkewedInfo field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetSkewedInfo(v *SkewedInfo) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.SkewedInfo = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSortColumns sets the SortColumns field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetSortColumns(v []*Order) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.SortColumns = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStoredAsSubDirectories sets the StoredAsSubDirectories field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageDescriptor) SetStoredAsSubDirectories(v bool) *StorageDescriptor {
|
|
s.StoredAsSubDirectories = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Represents a collection of related data organized in columns and rows.
|
|
type Table struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Time when the table definition was created in the Data Catalog.
|
|
CreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Person or entity who created the table.
|
|
CreatedBy *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the metadata database where the table metadata resides. For Hive
|
|
// compatibility, this must be all lowercase.
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the table.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Last time the table was accessed. This is usually taken from HDFS, and may
|
|
// not be reliable.
|
|
LastAccessTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Last time column statistics were computed for this table.
|
|
LastAnalyzedTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the table. For Hive compatibility, this must be entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Owner of the table.
|
|
Owner *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// These key-value pairs define properties associated with the table.
|
|
Parameters map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of columns by which the table is partitioned. Only primitive types
|
|
// are supported as partition keys.
|
|
PartitionKeys []*Column `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Retention time for this table.
|
|
Retention *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A storage descriptor containing information about the physical storage of
|
|
// this table.
|
|
StorageDescriptor *StorageDescriptor `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of this table (EXTERNAL_TABLE, VIRTUAL_VIEW, etc.).
|
|
TableType *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Last time the table was updated.
|
|
UpdateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// If the table is a view, the expanded text of the view; otherwise null.
|
|
ViewExpandedText *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the table is a view, the original text of the view; otherwise null.
|
|
ViewOriginalText *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Table) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Table) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreateTime sets the CreateTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetCreateTime(v time.Time) *Table {
|
|
s.CreateTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreatedBy sets the CreatedBy field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetCreatedBy(v string) *Table {
|
|
s.CreatedBy = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetDatabaseName(v string) *Table {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetDescription(v string) *Table {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastAccessTime sets the LastAccessTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetLastAccessTime(v time.Time) *Table {
|
|
s.LastAccessTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastAnalyzedTime sets the LastAnalyzedTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetLastAnalyzedTime(v time.Time) *Table {
|
|
s.LastAnalyzedTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetName(v string) *Table {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetOwner(v string) *Table {
|
|
s.Owner = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetParameters(v map[string]*string) *Table {
|
|
s.Parameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionKeys sets the PartitionKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetPartitionKeys(v []*Column) *Table {
|
|
s.PartitionKeys = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRetention sets the Retention field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetRetention(v int64) *Table {
|
|
s.Retention = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageDescriptor sets the StorageDescriptor field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetStorageDescriptor(v *StorageDescriptor) *Table {
|
|
s.StorageDescriptor = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableType sets the TableType field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetTableType(v string) *Table {
|
|
s.TableType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUpdateTime sets the UpdateTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetUpdateTime(v time.Time) *Table {
|
|
s.UpdateTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetViewExpandedText sets the ViewExpandedText field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetViewExpandedText(v string) *Table {
|
|
s.ViewExpandedText = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetViewOriginalText sets the ViewOriginalText field's value.
|
|
func (s *Table) SetViewOriginalText(v string) *Table {
|
|
s.ViewOriginalText = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// An error record for table operations.
|
|
type TableError struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Detail about the error.
|
|
ErrorDetail *ErrorDetail `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the table. For Hive compatibility, this must be entirely lowercase.
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TableError) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TableError) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorDetail sets the ErrorDetail field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableError) SetErrorDetail(v *ErrorDetail) *TableError {
|
|
s.ErrorDetail = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableError) SetTableName(v string) *TableError {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Structure used to create or update the table.
|
|
type TableInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Description of the table.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Last time the table was accessed.
|
|
LastAccessTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Last time column statistics were computed for this table.
|
|
LastAnalyzedTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the table. For Hive compatibility, this is folded to lowercase when
|
|
// it is stored.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Owner of the table.
|
|
Owner *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// These key-value pairs define properties associated with the table.
|
|
Parameters map[string]*string `type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of columns by which the table is partitioned. Only primitive types
|
|
// are supported as partition keys.
|
|
PartitionKeys []*Column `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Retention time for this table.
|
|
Retention *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A storage descriptor containing information about the physical storage of
|
|
// this table.
|
|
StorageDescriptor *StorageDescriptor `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of this table (EXTERNAL_TABLE, VIRTUAL_VIEW, etc.).
|
|
TableType *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the table is a view, the expanded text of the view; otherwise null.
|
|
ViewExpandedText *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the table is a view, the original text of the view; otherwise null.
|
|
ViewOriginalText *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TableInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TableInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "TableInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Owner != nil && len(*s.Owner) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Owner", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionKeys != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.PartitionKeys {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "PartitionKeys", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.StorageDescriptor != nil {
|
|
if err := s.StorageDescriptor.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("StorageDescriptor", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetDescription(v string) *TableInput {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastAccessTime sets the LastAccessTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetLastAccessTime(v time.Time) *TableInput {
|
|
s.LastAccessTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastAnalyzedTime sets the LastAnalyzedTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetLastAnalyzedTime(v time.Time) *TableInput {
|
|
s.LastAnalyzedTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetName(v string) *TableInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetOwner(v string) *TableInput {
|
|
s.Owner = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetParameters(v map[string]*string) *TableInput {
|
|
s.Parameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionKeys sets the PartitionKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetPartitionKeys(v []*Column) *TableInput {
|
|
s.PartitionKeys = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRetention sets the Retention field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetRetention(v int64) *TableInput {
|
|
s.Retention = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageDescriptor sets the StorageDescriptor field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetStorageDescriptor(v *StorageDescriptor) *TableInput {
|
|
s.StorageDescriptor = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableType sets the TableType field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetTableType(v string) *TableInput {
|
|
s.TableType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetViewExpandedText sets the ViewExpandedText field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetViewExpandedText(v string) *TableInput {
|
|
s.ViewExpandedText = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetViewOriginalText sets the ViewOriginalText field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableInput) SetViewOriginalText(v string) *TableInput {
|
|
s.ViewOriginalText = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a version of a table.
|
|
type TableVersion struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The table in question
|
|
Table *Table `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID value that identifies this table version.
|
|
VersionId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TableVersion) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TableVersion) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTable sets the Table field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableVersion) SetTable(v *Table) *TableVersion {
|
|
s.Table = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableVersion) SetVersionId(v string) *TableVersion {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// An error record for table-version operations.
|
|
type TableVersionError struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Detail about the error.
|
|
ErrorDetail *ErrorDetail `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table in question.
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID value of the version in question.
|
|
VersionId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TableVersionError) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TableVersionError) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorDetail sets the ErrorDetail field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableVersionError) SetErrorDetail(v *ErrorDetail) *TableVersionError {
|
|
s.ErrorDetail = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableVersionError) SetTableName(v string) *TableVersionError {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *TableVersionError) SetVersionId(v string) *TableVersionError {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Information about a specific trigger.
|
|
type Trigger struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The actions initiated by this trigger.
|
|
Actions []*Action `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A description of this trigger.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Reserved for future use.
|
|
Id *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the trigger.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The predicate of this trigger, which defines when it will fire.
|
|
Predicate *Predicate `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A cron expression used to specify the schedule (see Time-Based Schedules
|
|
// for Jobs and Crawlers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/monitor-data-warehouse-schedule.html).
|
|
// For example, to run something every day at 12:15 UTC, you would specify:
|
|
// cron(15 12 * * ? *).
|
|
Schedule *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The current state of the trigger.
|
|
State *string `type:"string" enum:"TriggerState"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of trigger that this is.
|
|
Type *string `type:"string" enum:"TriggerType"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Trigger) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Trigger) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetActions sets the Actions field's value.
|
|
func (s *Trigger) SetActions(v []*Action) *Trigger {
|
|
s.Actions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *Trigger) SetDescription(v string) *Trigger {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *Trigger) SetId(v string) *Trigger {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Trigger) SetName(v string) *Trigger {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPredicate sets the Predicate field's value.
|
|
func (s *Trigger) SetPredicate(v *Predicate) *Trigger {
|
|
s.Predicate = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchedule sets the Schedule field's value.
|
|
func (s *Trigger) SetSchedule(v string) *Trigger {
|
|
s.Schedule = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *Trigger) SetState(v string) *Trigger {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *Trigger) SetType(v string) *Trigger {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A structure used to provide information used to update a trigger. This object
|
|
// will update the the previous trigger definition by overwriting it completely.
|
|
type TriggerUpdate struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The actions initiated by this trigger.
|
|
Actions []*Action `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A description of this trigger.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Reserved for future use.
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The predicate of this trigger, which defines when it will fire.
|
|
Predicate *Predicate `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A cron expression used to specify the schedule (see Time-Based Schedules
|
|
// for Jobs and Crawlers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/monitor-data-warehouse-schedule.html).
|
|
// For example, to run something every day at 12:15 UTC, you would specify:
|
|
// cron(15 12 * * ? *).
|
|
Schedule *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TriggerUpdate) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TriggerUpdate) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *TriggerUpdate) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "TriggerUpdate"}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Actions != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Actions {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Actions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Predicate != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Predicate.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Predicate", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetActions sets the Actions field's value.
|
|
func (s *TriggerUpdate) SetActions(v []*Action) *TriggerUpdate {
|
|
s.Actions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *TriggerUpdate) SetDescription(v string) *TriggerUpdate {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *TriggerUpdate) SetName(v string) *TriggerUpdate {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPredicate sets the Predicate field's value.
|
|
func (s *TriggerUpdate) SetPredicate(v *Predicate) *TriggerUpdate {
|
|
s.Predicate = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchedule sets the Schedule field's value.
|
|
func (s *TriggerUpdate) SetSchedule(v string) *TriggerUpdate {
|
|
s.Schedule = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateClassifierInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A GrokClassifier object with updated fields.
|
|
GrokClassifier *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A JsonClassifier object with updated fields.
|
|
JsonClassifier *UpdateJsonClassifierRequest `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An XMLClassifier object with updated fields.
|
|
XMLClassifier *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateClassifierInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateClassifierInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateClassifierInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateClassifierInput"}
|
|
if s.GrokClassifier != nil {
|
|
if err := s.GrokClassifier.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("GrokClassifier", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JsonClassifier != nil {
|
|
if err := s.JsonClassifier.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("JsonClassifier", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.XMLClassifier != nil {
|
|
if err := s.XMLClassifier.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("XMLClassifier", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrokClassifier sets the GrokClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateClassifierInput) SetGrokClassifier(v *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest) *UpdateClassifierInput {
|
|
s.GrokClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJsonClassifier sets the JsonClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateClassifierInput) SetJsonClassifier(v *UpdateJsonClassifierRequest) *UpdateClassifierInput {
|
|
s.JsonClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetXMLClassifier sets the XMLClassifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateClassifierInput) SetXMLClassifier(v *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest) *UpdateClassifierInput {
|
|
s.XMLClassifier = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateClassifierOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateClassifierOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateClassifierOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateConnectionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which the connection resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A ConnectionInput object that redefines the connection in question.
|
|
//
|
|
// ConnectionInput is a required field
|
|
ConnectionInput *ConnectionInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the connection definition to update.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateConnectionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateConnectionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateConnectionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateConnectionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ConnectionInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ConnectionInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ConnectionInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ConnectionInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ConnectionInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateConnectionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *UpdateConnectionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionInput sets the ConnectionInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateConnectionInput) SetConnectionInput(v *ConnectionInput) *UpdateConnectionInput {
|
|
s.ConnectionInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateConnectionInput) SetName(v string) *UpdateConnectionInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateConnectionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateConnectionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateConnectionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateCrawlerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of custom classifiers that the user has registered. By default, all
|
|
// built-in classifiers are included in a crawl, but these custom classifiers
|
|
// always override the default classifiers for a given classification.
|
|
Classifiers []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Crawler configuration information. This versioned JSON string allows users
|
|
// to specify aspects of a Crawler's behavior.
|
|
//
|
|
// You can use this field to force partitions to inherit metadata such as classification,
|
|
// input format, output format, serde information, and schema from their parent
|
|
// table, rather than detect this information separately for each partition.
|
|
// Use the following JSON string to specify that behavior:
|
|
//
|
|
// Example: '{ "Version": 1.0, "CrawlerOutput": { "Partitions": { "AddOrUpdateBehavior":
|
|
// "InheritFromTable" } } }'
|
|
Configuration *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the SecurityConfiguration structure to be used by this Crawler.
|
|
CrawlerSecurityConfiguration *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The AWS Glue database where results are stored, such as: arn:aws:daylight:us-east-1::database/sometable/*.
|
|
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A description of the new crawler.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the new crawler.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The IAM role (or ARN of an IAM role) used by the new crawler to access customer
|
|
// resources.
|
|
Role *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A cron expression used to specify the schedule (see Time-Based Schedules
|
|
// for Jobs and Crawlers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/monitor-data-warehouse-schedule.html).
|
|
// For example, to run something every day at 12:15 UTC, you would specify:
|
|
// cron(15 12 * * ? *).
|
|
Schedule *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Policy for the crawler's update and deletion behavior.
|
|
SchemaChangePolicy *SchemaChangePolicy `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The table prefix used for catalog tables that are created.
|
|
TablePrefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of targets to crawl.
|
|
Targets *CrawlerTargets `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateCrawlerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateCrawlerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateCrawlerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassifiers sets the Classifiers field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetClassifiers(v []*string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Classifiers = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConfiguration sets the Configuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetConfiguration(v string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Configuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerSecurityConfiguration sets the CrawlerSecurityConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetCrawlerSecurityConfiguration(v string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.CrawlerSecurityConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetDescription(v string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetName(v string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRole sets the Role field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetRole(v string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Role = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchedule sets the Schedule field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetSchedule(v string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Schedule = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchemaChangePolicy sets the SchemaChangePolicy field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetSchemaChangePolicy(v *SchemaChangePolicy) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.SchemaChangePolicy = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTablePrefix sets the TablePrefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetTablePrefix(v string) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.TablePrefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargets sets the Targets field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerInput) SetTargets(v *CrawlerTargets) *UpdateCrawlerInput {
|
|
s.Targets = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateCrawlerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateCrawlerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateCrawlerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the crawler whose schedule to update.
|
|
//
|
|
// CrawlerName is a required field
|
|
CrawlerName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The updated cron expression used to specify the schedule (see Time-Based
|
|
// Schedules for Jobs and Crawlers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/monitor-data-warehouse-schedule.html).
|
|
// For example, to run something every day at 12:15 UTC, you would specify:
|
|
// cron(15 12 * * ? *).
|
|
Schedule *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput"}
|
|
if s.CrawlerName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CrawlerName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CrawlerName != nil && len(*s.CrawlerName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CrawlerName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCrawlerName sets the CrawlerName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput) SetCrawlerName(v string) *UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput {
|
|
s.CrawlerName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchedule sets the Schedule field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput) SetSchedule(v string) *UpdateCrawlerScheduleInput {
|
|
s.Schedule = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateCrawlerScheduleOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateCrawlerScheduleOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateCrawlerScheduleOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateDatabaseInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog in which the metadata database resides. If none
|
|
// is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A DatabaseInput object specifying the new definition of the metadata database
|
|
// in the catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseInput is a required field
|
|
DatabaseInput *DatabaseInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the database to update in the catalog. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this is folded to lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateDatabaseInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateDatabaseInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDatabaseInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateDatabaseInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DatabaseInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DatabaseInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDatabaseInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *UpdateDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseInput sets the DatabaseInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDatabaseInput) SetDatabaseInput(v *DatabaseInput) *UpdateDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDatabaseInput) SetName(v string) *UpdateDatabaseInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateDatabaseOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateDatabaseOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateDatabaseOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateDevEndpointInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of public keys for the DevEndpoint to use.
|
|
AddPublicKeys []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Custom Python or Java libraries to be loaded in the DevEndpoint.
|
|
CustomLibraries *DevEndpointCustomLibraries `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of public keys to be deleted from the DevEndpoint.
|
|
DeletePublicKeys []*string `type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the DevEndpoint to be updated.
|
|
//
|
|
// EndpointName is a required field
|
|
EndpointName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The public key for the DevEndpoint to use.
|
|
PublicKey *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// True if the list of custom libraries to be loaded in the development endpoint
|
|
// needs to be updated, or False otherwise.
|
|
UpdateEtlLibraries *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateDevEndpointInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateDevEndpointInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDevEndpointInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateDevEndpointInput"}
|
|
if s.EndpointName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EndpointName"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAddPublicKeys sets the AddPublicKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDevEndpointInput) SetAddPublicKeys(v []*string) *UpdateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.AddPublicKeys = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCustomLibraries sets the CustomLibraries field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDevEndpointInput) SetCustomLibraries(v *DevEndpointCustomLibraries) *UpdateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.CustomLibraries = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeletePublicKeys sets the DeletePublicKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDevEndpointInput) SetDeletePublicKeys(v []*string) *UpdateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.DeletePublicKeys = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEndpointName sets the EndpointName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDevEndpointInput) SetEndpointName(v string) *UpdateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.EndpointName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPublicKey sets the PublicKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDevEndpointInput) SetPublicKey(v string) *UpdateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.PublicKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUpdateEtlLibraries sets the UpdateEtlLibraries field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateDevEndpointInput) SetUpdateEtlLibraries(v bool) *UpdateDevEndpointInput {
|
|
s.UpdateEtlLibraries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateDevEndpointOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateDevEndpointOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateDevEndpointOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a grok classifier to update when passed to UpdateClassifier.
|
|
type UpdateGrokClassifierRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An identifier of the data format that the classifier matches, such as Twitter,
|
|
// JSON, Omniture logs, Amazon CloudWatch Logs, and so on.
|
|
Classification *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Optional custom grok patterns used by this classifier.
|
|
CustomPatterns *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The grok pattern used by this classifier.
|
|
GrokPattern *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the GrokClassifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateGrokClassifierRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateGrokClassifierRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateGrokClassifierRequest"}
|
|
if s.GrokPattern != nil && len(*s.GrokPattern) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GrokPattern", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassification sets the Classification field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest) SetClassification(v string) *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Classification = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCustomPatterns sets the CustomPatterns field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest) SetCustomPatterns(v string) *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.CustomPatterns = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrokPattern sets the GrokPattern field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest) SetGrokPattern(v string) *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.GrokPattern = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest) SetName(v string) *UpdateGrokClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateJobInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the job definition to update.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobName is a required field
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the values with which to update the job definition.
|
|
//
|
|
// JobUpdate is a required field
|
|
JobUpdate *JobUpdate `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateJobInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateJobInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateJobInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateJobInput"}
|
|
if s.JobName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobName != nil && len(*s.JobName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("JobName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobUpdate == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("JobUpdate"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.JobUpdate != nil {
|
|
if err := s.JobUpdate.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("JobUpdate", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateJobInput) SetJobName(v string) *UpdateJobInput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobUpdate sets the JobUpdate field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateJobInput) SetJobUpdate(v *JobUpdate) *UpdateJobInput {
|
|
s.JobUpdate = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateJobOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Returns the name of the updated job definition.
|
|
JobName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateJobOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateJobOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJobName sets the JobName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateJobOutput) SetJobName(v string) *UpdateJobOutput {
|
|
s.JobName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a JSON classifier to be updated.
|
|
type UpdateJsonClassifierRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A JsonPath string defining the JSON data for the classifier to classify.
|
|
// AWS Glue supports a subset of JsonPath, as described in Writing JsonPath
|
|
// Custom Classifiers (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/glue/latest/dg/custom-classifier.html#custom-classifier-json).
|
|
JsonPath *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateJsonClassifierRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateJsonClassifierRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateJsonClassifierRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateJsonClassifierRequest"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJsonPath sets the JsonPath field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateJsonClassifierRequest) SetJsonPath(v string) *UpdateJsonClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.JsonPath = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateJsonClassifierRequest) SetName(v string) *UpdateJsonClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdatePartitionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the partition to be updated resides. If
|
|
// none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database in which the table in question resides.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The new partition object to which to update the partition.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartitionInput is a required field
|
|
PartitionInput *PartitionInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the values defining the partition.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartitionValueList is a required field
|
|
PartitionValueList []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the table where the partition to be updated is located.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableName is a required field
|
|
TableName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdatePartitionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdatePartitionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdatePartitionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdatePartitionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartitionInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionValueList == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartitionValueList"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableName != nil && len(*s.TableName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("TableName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartitionInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.PartitionInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("PartitionInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdatePartitionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *UpdatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdatePartitionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *UpdatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionInput sets the PartitionInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdatePartitionInput) SetPartitionInput(v *PartitionInput) *UpdatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.PartitionInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartitionValueList sets the PartitionValueList field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdatePartitionInput) SetPartitionValueList(v []*string) *UpdatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.PartitionValueList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableName sets the TableName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdatePartitionInput) SetTableName(v string) *UpdatePartitionInput {
|
|
s.TableName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdatePartitionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdatePartitionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdatePartitionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateTableInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the table resides. If none is supplied,
|
|
// the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database in which the table resides. For Hive compatibility,
|
|
// this name is entirely lowercase.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// By default, UpdateTable always creates an archived version of the table before
|
|
// updating it. If skipArchive is set to true, however, UpdateTable does not
|
|
// create the archived version.
|
|
SkipArchive *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// An updated TableInput object to define the metadata table in the catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// TableInput is a required field
|
|
TableInput *TableInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateTableInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateTableInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTableInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateTableInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TableInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TableInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.TableInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("TableInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTableInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *UpdateTableInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTableInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *UpdateTableInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSkipArchive sets the SkipArchive field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTableInput) SetSkipArchive(v bool) *UpdateTableInput {
|
|
s.SkipArchive = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTableInput sets the TableInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTableInput) SetTableInput(v *TableInput) *UpdateTableInput {
|
|
s.TableInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateTableOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateTableOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateTableOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateTriggerInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the trigger to update.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The new values with which to update the trigger.
|
|
//
|
|
// TriggerUpdate is a required field
|
|
TriggerUpdate *TriggerUpdate `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateTriggerInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateTriggerInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTriggerInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateTriggerInput"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TriggerUpdate == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TriggerUpdate"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TriggerUpdate != nil {
|
|
if err := s.TriggerUpdate.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("TriggerUpdate", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTriggerInput) SetName(v string) *UpdateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTriggerUpdate sets the TriggerUpdate field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTriggerInput) SetTriggerUpdate(v *TriggerUpdate) *UpdateTriggerInput {
|
|
s.TriggerUpdate = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateTriggerOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The resulting trigger definition.
|
|
Trigger *Trigger `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateTriggerOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateTriggerOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTrigger sets the Trigger field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateTriggerOutput) SetTrigger(v *Trigger) *UpdateTriggerOutput {
|
|
s.Trigger = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the Data Catalog where the function to be updated is located. If
|
|
// none is supplied, the AWS account ID is used by default.
|
|
CatalogId *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the catalog database where the function to be updated is located.
|
|
//
|
|
// DatabaseName is a required field
|
|
DatabaseName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A FunctionInput object that re-defines the function in the Data Catalog.
|
|
//
|
|
// FunctionInput is a required field
|
|
FunctionInput *UserDefinedFunctionInput `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the function.
|
|
//
|
|
// FunctionName is a required field
|
|
FunctionName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput"}
|
|
if s.CatalogId != nil && len(*s.CatalogId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CatalogId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DatabaseName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DatabaseName != nil && len(*s.DatabaseName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DatabaseName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionInput == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FunctionInput"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FunctionName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionName != nil && len(*s.FunctionName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("FunctionName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionInput != nil {
|
|
if err := s.FunctionInput.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("FunctionInput", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCatalogId sets the CatalogId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetCatalogId(v string) *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.CatalogId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.DatabaseName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFunctionInput sets the FunctionInput field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetFunctionInput(v *UserDefinedFunctionInput) *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.FunctionInput = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFunctionName sets the FunctionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput) SetFunctionName(v string) *UpdateUserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.FunctionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateUserDefinedFunctionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateUserDefinedFunctionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateUserDefinedFunctionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies an XML classifier to be updated.
|
|
type UpdateXMLClassifierRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An identifier of the data format that the classifier matches.
|
|
Classification *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The XML tag designating the element that contains each record in an XML document
|
|
// being parsed. Note that this cannot identify a self-closing element (closed
|
|
// by />). An empty row element that contains only attributes can be parsed
|
|
// as long as it ends with a closing tag (for example, <row item_a="A" item_b="B"></row>
|
|
// is okay, but <row item_a="A" item_b="B" /> is not).
|
|
RowTag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateXMLClassifierRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateXMLClassifierRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateXMLClassifierRequest"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassification sets the Classification field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest) SetClassification(v string) *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Classification = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest) SetName(v string) *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRowTag sets the RowTag field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest) SetRowTag(v string) *UpdateXMLClassifierRequest {
|
|
s.RowTag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Represents the equivalent of a Hive user-defined function (UDF) definition.
|
|
type UserDefinedFunction struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Java class that contains the function code.
|
|
ClassName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The time at which the function was created.
|
|
CreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the function.
|
|
FunctionName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The owner of the function.
|
|
OwnerName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The owner type.
|
|
OwnerType *string `type:"string" enum:"PrincipalType"`
|
|
|
|
// The resource URIs for the function.
|
|
ResourceUris []*ResourceUri `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UserDefinedFunction) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UserDefinedFunction) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassName sets the ClassName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunction) SetClassName(v string) *UserDefinedFunction {
|
|
s.ClassName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreateTime sets the CreateTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunction) SetCreateTime(v time.Time) *UserDefinedFunction {
|
|
s.CreateTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFunctionName sets the FunctionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunction) SetFunctionName(v string) *UserDefinedFunction {
|
|
s.FunctionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwnerName sets the OwnerName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunction) SetOwnerName(v string) *UserDefinedFunction {
|
|
s.OwnerName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwnerType sets the OwnerType field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunction) SetOwnerType(v string) *UserDefinedFunction {
|
|
s.OwnerType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceUris sets the ResourceUris field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunction) SetResourceUris(v []*ResourceUri) *UserDefinedFunction {
|
|
s.ResourceUris = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A structure used to create or updata a user-defined function.
|
|
type UserDefinedFunctionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Java class that contains the function code.
|
|
ClassName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the function.
|
|
FunctionName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The owner of the function.
|
|
OwnerName *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The owner type.
|
|
OwnerType *string `type:"string" enum:"PrincipalType"`
|
|
|
|
// The resource URIs for the function.
|
|
ResourceUris []*ResourceUri `type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UserDefinedFunctionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UserDefinedFunctionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunctionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UserDefinedFunctionInput"}
|
|
if s.ClassName != nil && len(*s.ClassName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ClassName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FunctionName != nil && len(*s.FunctionName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("FunctionName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OwnerName != nil && len(*s.OwnerName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OwnerName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ResourceUris != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.ResourceUris {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "ResourceUris", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassName sets the ClassName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunctionInput) SetClassName(v string) *UserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.ClassName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFunctionName sets the FunctionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunctionInput) SetFunctionName(v string) *UserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.FunctionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwnerName sets the OwnerName field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunctionInput) SetOwnerName(v string) *UserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.OwnerName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwnerType sets the OwnerType field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunctionInput) SetOwnerType(v string) *UserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.OwnerType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceUris sets the ResourceUris field's value.
|
|
func (s *UserDefinedFunctionInput) SetResourceUris(v []*ResourceUri) *UserDefinedFunctionInput {
|
|
s.ResourceUris = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A classifier for XML content.
|
|
type XMLClassifier struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An identifier of the data format that the classifier matches.
|
|
//
|
|
// Classification is a required field
|
|
Classification *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The time this classifier was registered.
|
|
CreationTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The time this classifier was last updated.
|
|
LastUpdated *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the classifier.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The XML tag designating the element that contains each record in an XML document
|
|
// being parsed. Note that this cannot identify a self-closing element (closed
|
|
// by />). An empty row element that contains only attributes can be parsed
|
|
// as long as it ends with a closing tag (for example, <row item_a="A" item_b="B"></row>
|
|
// is okay, but <row item_a="A" item_b="B" /> is not).
|
|
RowTag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The version of this classifier.
|
|
Version *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s XMLClassifier) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s XMLClassifier) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClassification sets the Classification field's value.
|
|
func (s *XMLClassifier) SetClassification(v string) *XMLClassifier {
|
|
s.Classification = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreationTime sets the CreationTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *XMLClassifier) SetCreationTime(v time.Time) *XMLClassifier {
|
|
s.CreationTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastUpdated sets the LastUpdated field's value.
|
|
func (s *XMLClassifier) SetLastUpdated(v time.Time) *XMLClassifier {
|
|
s.LastUpdated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *XMLClassifier) SetName(v string) *XMLClassifier {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRowTag sets the RowTag field's value.
|
|
func (s *XMLClassifier) SetRowTag(v string) *XMLClassifier {
|
|
s.RowTag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersion sets the Version field's value.
|
|
func (s *XMLClassifier) SetVersion(v int64) *XMLClassifier {
|
|
s.Version = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// CatalogEncryptionModeDisabled is a CatalogEncryptionMode enum value
|
|
CatalogEncryptionModeDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// CatalogEncryptionModeSseKms is a CatalogEncryptionMode enum value
|
|
CatalogEncryptionModeSseKms = "SSE-KMS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// CloudWatchEncryptionModeDisabled is a CloudWatchEncryptionMode enum value
|
|
CloudWatchEncryptionModeDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// CloudWatchEncryptionModeSseKms is a CloudWatchEncryptionMode enum value
|
|
CloudWatchEncryptionModeSseKms = "SSE-KMS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyHost is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyHost = "HOST"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyPort is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyPort = "PORT"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyUsername is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyUsername = "USERNAME"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyPassword is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyPassword = "PASSWORD"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcDriverJarUri is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcDriverJarUri = "JDBC_DRIVER_JAR_URI"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcDriverClassName is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcDriverClassName = "JDBC_DRIVER_CLASS_NAME"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcEngine is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcEngine = "JDBC_ENGINE"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcEngineVersion is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcEngineVersion = "JDBC_ENGINE_VERSION"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyConfigFiles is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyConfigFiles = "CONFIG_FILES"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyInstanceId is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyInstanceId = "INSTANCE_ID"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcConnectionUrl is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcConnectionUrl = "JDBC_CONNECTION_URL"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcEnforceSsl is a ConnectionPropertyKey enum value
|
|
ConnectionPropertyKeyJdbcEnforceSsl = "JDBC_ENFORCE_SSL"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ConnectionTypeJdbc is a ConnectionType enum value
|
|
ConnectionTypeJdbc = "JDBC"
|
|
|
|
// ConnectionTypeSftp is a ConnectionType enum value
|
|
ConnectionTypeSftp = "SFTP"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// CrawlerStateReady is a CrawlerState enum value
|
|
CrawlerStateReady = "READY"
|
|
|
|
// CrawlerStateRunning is a CrawlerState enum value
|
|
CrawlerStateRunning = "RUNNING"
|
|
|
|
// CrawlerStateStopping is a CrawlerState enum value
|
|
CrawlerStateStopping = "STOPPING"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DeleteBehaviorLog is a DeleteBehavior enum value
|
|
DeleteBehaviorLog = "LOG"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBehaviorDeleteFromDatabase is a DeleteBehavior enum value
|
|
DeleteBehaviorDeleteFromDatabase = "DELETE_FROM_DATABASE"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBehaviorDeprecateInDatabase is a DeleteBehavior enum value
|
|
DeleteBehaviorDeprecateInDatabase = "DEPRECATE_IN_DATABASE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// JobBookmarksEncryptionModeDisabled is a JobBookmarksEncryptionMode enum value
|
|
JobBookmarksEncryptionModeDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// JobBookmarksEncryptionModeCseKms is a JobBookmarksEncryptionMode enum value
|
|
JobBookmarksEncryptionModeCseKms = "CSE-KMS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// JobRunStateStarting is a JobRunState enum value
|
|
JobRunStateStarting = "STARTING"
|
|
|
|
// JobRunStateRunning is a JobRunState enum value
|
|
JobRunStateRunning = "RUNNING"
|
|
|
|
// JobRunStateStopping is a JobRunState enum value
|
|
JobRunStateStopping = "STOPPING"
|
|
|
|
// JobRunStateStopped is a JobRunState enum value
|
|
JobRunStateStopped = "STOPPED"
|
|
|
|
// JobRunStateSucceeded is a JobRunState enum value
|
|
JobRunStateSucceeded = "SUCCEEDED"
|
|
|
|
// JobRunStateFailed is a JobRunState enum value
|
|
JobRunStateFailed = "FAILED"
|
|
|
|
// JobRunStateTimeout is a JobRunState enum value
|
|
JobRunStateTimeout = "TIMEOUT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// LanguagePython is a Language enum value
|
|
LanguagePython = "PYTHON"
|
|
|
|
// LanguageScala is a Language enum value
|
|
LanguageScala = "SCALA"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// LastCrawlStatusSucceeded is a LastCrawlStatus enum value
|
|
LastCrawlStatusSucceeded = "SUCCEEDED"
|
|
|
|
// LastCrawlStatusCancelled is a LastCrawlStatus enum value
|
|
LastCrawlStatusCancelled = "CANCELLED"
|
|
|
|
// LastCrawlStatusFailed is a LastCrawlStatus enum value
|
|
LastCrawlStatusFailed = "FAILED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// LogicalAnd is a Logical enum value
|
|
LogicalAnd = "AND"
|
|
|
|
// LogicalAny is a Logical enum value
|
|
LogicalAny = "ANY"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// LogicalOperatorEquals is a LogicalOperator enum value
|
|
LogicalOperatorEquals = "EQUALS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// PrincipalTypeUser is a PrincipalType enum value
|
|
PrincipalTypeUser = "USER"
|
|
|
|
// PrincipalTypeRole is a PrincipalType enum value
|
|
PrincipalTypeRole = "ROLE"
|
|
|
|
// PrincipalTypeGroup is a PrincipalType enum value
|
|
PrincipalTypeGroup = "GROUP"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ResourceTypeJar is a ResourceType enum value
|
|
ResourceTypeJar = "JAR"
|
|
|
|
// ResourceTypeFile is a ResourceType enum value
|
|
ResourceTypeFile = "FILE"
|
|
|
|
// ResourceTypeArchive is a ResourceType enum value
|
|
ResourceTypeArchive = "ARCHIVE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// S3EncryptionModeDisabled is a S3EncryptionMode enum value
|
|
S3EncryptionModeDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// S3EncryptionModeSseKms is a S3EncryptionMode enum value
|
|
S3EncryptionModeSseKms = "SSE-KMS"
|
|
|
|
// S3EncryptionModeSseS3 is a S3EncryptionMode enum value
|
|
S3EncryptionModeSseS3 = "SSE-S3"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ScheduleStateScheduled is a ScheduleState enum value
|
|
ScheduleStateScheduled = "SCHEDULED"
|
|
|
|
// ScheduleStateNotScheduled is a ScheduleState enum value
|
|
ScheduleStateNotScheduled = "NOT_SCHEDULED"
|
|
|
|
// ScheduleStateTransitioning is a ScheduleState enum value
|
|
ScheduleStateTransitioning = "TRANSITIONING"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// TriggerStateCreating is a TriggerState enum value
|
|
TriggerStateCreating = "CREATING"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerStateCreated is a TriggerState enum value
|
|
TriggerStateCreated = "CREATED"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerStateActivating is a TriggerState enum value
|
|
TriggerStateActivating = "ACTIVATING"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerStateActivated is a TriggerState enum value
|
|
TriggerStateActivated = "ACTIVATED"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerStateDeactivating is a TriggerState enum value
|
|
TriggerStateDeactivating = "DEACTIVATING"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerStateDeactivated is a TriggerState enum value
|
|
TriggerStateDeactivated = "DEACTIVATED"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerStateDeleting is a TriggerState enum value
|
|
TriggerStateDeleting = "DELETING"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerStateUpdating is a TriggerState enum value
|
|
TriggerStateUpdating = "UPDATING"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// TriggerTypeScheduled is a TriggerType enum value
|
|
TriggerTypeScheduled = "SCHEDULED"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerTypeConditional is a TriggerType enum value
|
|
TriggerTypeConditional = "CONDITIONAL"
|
|
|
|
// TriggerTypeOnDemand is a TriggerType enum value
|
|
TriggerTypeOnDemand = "ON_DEMAND"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// UpdateBehaviorLog is a UpdateBehavior enum value
|
|
UpdateBehaviorLog = "LOG"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateBehaviorUpdateInDatabase is a UpdateBehavior enum value
|
|
UpdateBehaviorUpdateInDatabase = "UPDATE_IN_DATABASE"
|
|
)
|